5800 MSAM 40100G GettingStarted

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 244

T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800

Multiple Services Application Module, 40/100G


Transport Module, 100G Services Application
Module, Dual Module Carrier, and Handheld
Network Test Family

Getting Started Manual


T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800
Multiple Services Application Module, 40/100G Transport
Module, 100G Services Application Module, Dual Module
Carrier, and Handheld Network Test Family

Getting Started Manual

Network and Service Enablement


One Milestone Center Court
Germantown, Maryland 20876-7100 USA
Toll Free 1-855-ASK-JDSU • Tel +1-301-353-1560 • Fax +1-240-404-1996
www.jdsu.com
Notice
Every effort was made to ensure that the information in this document was accurate at the time of
printing. However, information is subject to change without notice, and JDS Uniphase reserves the
right to provide an addendum to this document with information not available at the time that this
document was created.

Copyright
© Copyright 2014 JDS Uniphase Corporation. All rights reserved. JDSU, Network and Service
Enablement, and the JDSU logo are trademarks of JDS Uniphase Corporation (“JDS Uniphase”).
All other trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. No part
of this manual may be reproduced or transmitted electronically or otherwise without written permis-
sion of the publisher.

Copyright release
Reproduction and distribution of this guide is authorized for Government purposes only.

Trademarks
JDSU Uniphase, JDSU, MTS 8000, T-BERD 8000, MTS 6000A, T-BERD 6000A, MTS 5800 and
T-BERD 5800 are trademarks or registered trademarks of JDS Uniphase in the United States and/
or other countries.

Bluetooth is a registered trademark of The Bluetooth SIG, Inc. in the United States and/or other
countries.

Specifications, terms, and conditions are subject to change without notice. All trademarks and regis-
tered trademarks are the property of their respective companies.

Ordering information
The catalog number for a printed getting started manual is ML-22046563. The catalog number for
electronic manuals on USB is EML-22046537.

Terms and conditions


Specifications, terms, and conditions are subject to change without notice. The provision of hard-
ware, services, and/or software are subject to JDSU standard terms and conditions, available at
www.jdsu.com/terms.

FCC Notice
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device,
pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection
against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial installation. This
equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used
in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications.
Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference, in which
case, the user will be required to correct the interference at this own expense. However, there is no
guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
ii 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two con-
ditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) This device must accept any
interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be
determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the inter-
ference by one or more of the following measures:

– Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.


– Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
– Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is
connected.
– Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
In order to maintain compliance with the limits of a Class A digital device JDSU requires that quality
interface cables be used when connecting to this equipment. Any changes or modifications not
expressly approved by JDSU could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.

Industry Canada Requirements


This device complies with Industry Canada license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject
to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.

Le présent appareil est conforme aux CNR d'Industrie Canada applicables aux appareils radio
exempts de licence. L'exploitation est autorisée aux deux conditions suivantes: (1) l'appareil ne doit
pas produire de brouillage, et (2) l'utilisateur de l'appareil doit accepter tout brouillage radioélec-
trique subi, même si le brouillage est susceptible d'en compromettre le fonctionnement.

This Class A digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.

Cet appareil numérique de la classe A est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada.

WEEE and Battery Directive Compliance


JDSU has established processes in compliance with the Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment
(WEEE) Directive, 2002/96/EC, and the Battery Directive, 2006/66/EC.

This product, and the batteries used to power the product, should not be disposed of as unsorted
municipal waste and should be collected separately and disposed of according to your national
regulations. In the European Union, all equipment and batteries purchased from JDSU after 2005-
08-13 can be returned for disposal at the end of its useful life. JDSU will ensure that all waste equip-
ment and batteries returned are reused, recycled, or disposed of in an environmentally friendly
manner, and in compliance with all applicable national and international waste legislation.

It is the responsibility of the equipment owner to return equipment and batteries to JDSU for appro-
priate disposal. If the equipment or battery was imported by a reseller whose name or logo is
marked on the equipment or battery, then the owner should return the equipment or battery directly
to the reseller.

Instructions for returning waste equipment and batteries to JDSU can be found in the Environmental
section of the JDSU web site at www.jdsu.com. If you have questions concerning disposal of your
equipment or batteries, contact JDSU WEEE Program Management team at
[email protected].

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 iii
MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
iv 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Contents

About this Manual xv


Purpose and scope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvi
Assumptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvi
Terminology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvi
Getting Started Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xx
Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xx
Safety and compliance information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xxi
Technical assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xxii

Chapter 1 Overview 1
About the instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Features and capabilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Configuring your instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
What ships with your instrument? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Unpacking the components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Inspecting the components for damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
About the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Configuring the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Exploring the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
SFP+ connectors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
E3/DS3/STS-1/E4/STM1(e) connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
10/100/1000M connectors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
E1 connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
E1 RJ 48 transmitter/receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
DS1 connectors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
EXT CLK connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Headset/handset connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 v
Contents

USB host connector. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9


LAN connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Attaching a module to the 5800 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
About the Transport Module Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Determining your chassis version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Chassis requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
USB connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
External Reference SMA connector. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
QSFP+ 40G connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
CFP 40/100G connectors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
OC-192/STM-64/OTU-2/10GigE/10G FC connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
SFP connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
E3/DS3/STS-1/E4/STM1(e) connectors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
10/100/1000M connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
E1 connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
E1 RJ 48 transmitter/receiver. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
DS1 connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
About the CSAM Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Exploring the CSAM connector panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
External Clock Reference and Clock Out/1PPS connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
CFP2 40/100G connectors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
MPO Connectivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
QSFP+ 40G connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
SFP+ connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
About the MSAM Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
MSAM chassis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
MSAM PIMS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
About the DMC Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Base unit requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Inserting an SFP or XFP transceiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Removing an SFP or XFP transceiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
JDSU recommended SFPs and XFPs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30

Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument 31


Unpacking the components. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Inspecting the components for damage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Connecting a Transport Module or DMC to a base unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Key principles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Verifying the base unit requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Required tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Connecting the components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Connecting multiple Transport Modules to a base unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Connecting two DMCs to a base unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Inserting MSAMs or CSAMs into the 6000A base unit or DMC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
MSAM requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
CSAM requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
vi 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Contents

Required tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Inserting the MSAM or CSAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Inserting a PIM into the MSAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Removing a PIM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Swapping PIMs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Inserting a SFP/SFP+, XFP or QSFP+ transceiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Inserting a CFP or CFP2 transceiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Removing an SFP/SFP+, XFP or QSFP+ transceiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Removing a CFP or CFP2 transceiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Attaching an external optical connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Disconnecting the Transport Module or DMC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Required tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Disassembling the instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48

Chapter 3 Getting Started 51


Powering the instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Verifying that you have the correct adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Using the adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Turning on the instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Turning off the instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Charging the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
6000A Charge LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Launching the Transport Module or MSAM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Multiple BERT icons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
About the Jitter icon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Turning the BERT icon ON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Navigating the user interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Kinetic scrolling and gestures (5800v2 only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Menu Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Soft keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Setup/Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Menu Keys. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Message Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Quick Config settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Signal Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
LED Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Current and history LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
LED colors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
LEDs for muxed payloads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
10 Gigabit Ethernet WAN LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Actions Panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Result Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Result Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Setting up the instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Specifying international settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Setting the date and time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
MSAM and Transport Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
T-BERD / MTS 5800 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Checking the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Setting up the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 vii
Contents

Adjusting screen brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65


Setting up the screen saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Customizing the user interface look and feel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
TestPad mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
ANT mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Specifying the LED results mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Viewing or installing options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Loading upgrades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Synchronizing to the StrataSync server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Specifying a printer for the instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Preparing for optical testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Tuning XFPs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Testing 40G/100G Optics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Running the Optics Self-Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Generating a report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Connecting the Transport Module to the circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Configuring Expert settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Connecting the MSAM to the circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Connecting the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 to the circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Browsing the web. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Connecting to WiFi. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Playing videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81

Chapter 4 Basic Testing 83


Step 1: Selecting a test application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Step 2: Configuring a test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Displaying the setup screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Entering data in the setup fields. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Saving setups. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Understanding write-protected configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Step 3: Connecting the instrument to the circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Step 4: Starting the test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Using the Action buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Restarting a test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Step 5: Viewing test results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Setting the result group and category . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Expanding and collapsing result measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Changing the result layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Using the entire screen for results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Setting the blink option on errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
About histogram results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Viewing a histogram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
About the Event log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Viewing an event log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
About result graphs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Viewing graphs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Clearing History results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Creating and maintaining Custom result groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
viii 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Contents

Running multiple tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95


Restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Running multiple tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Viewing both tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Scheduling timed tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Creating and printing reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Including a logo in your reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Specifying report details. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Creating a report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Printing reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Generating reports automatically. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Viewing a report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Accessing test reports remotely. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Exporting reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Restoring test defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
VT-100 emulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Establishing a serial connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Running a VT-100 session . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Saving terminal screen data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
HTML Viewer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Launching the viewer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Navigating using the viewer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Scrolling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Finding text on a page. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Selecting links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Going back or forward one pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Going home. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Exiting the viewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109

Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting 111


Cleaning the instrument and optical connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Cleaning the instrument. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Cleaning optical connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Step 1: Gather cleaning materials . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Step 3: Clean the optical jack and the front shell. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Installing a front shell into an optical jack. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
Maintaining the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Recharging the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
Replacing the battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
Calibrating the touchscreen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Viewing the System Info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Adding options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Upgrading the software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Downloading from updatemyunit.net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Extracting the software to a USB stick. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Updating using a USB stick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Updating over a network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Retrograding the software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 ix
Contents

About troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122


Assembly and setup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Which transceivers are compatible with the instrument? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Can I hot-swap MSAMs? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Can I hot-swap PIMs? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Can I hot-swap transceivers?. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Can I do dual port testing from a single SFP PIM? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
No signal is detected when running 10 GigE application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Operating the instrument. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
How much space is available for my data? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Instrument will not power up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Can not print test results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Instrument shows an unused slot. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Instrument does not recognize USB stick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Performing tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Application does not appear on the Test menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Optical Overload Protection is activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
MSAM or Transport Module user interface is not launching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Test results are inconsistent. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Result values are blank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
No RFC 2544 or FC test buttons appear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Maintaining your instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
How often does the instrument need to be calibrated? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
What are the insertion rates for all components?. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Battery communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Battery gauge reading is inaccurate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127

Appendix A Specifications 129


T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Physical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Power specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Electrical Ethernet specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Clock source (Timing) specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
DS1 specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Transmitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Physical measurements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
E1 specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
E1 (RJ-48) specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Receiver (RJ-48) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Transmitter (RJ-48) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
E3/DS3/STS-1 specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Receiver (E3 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Transmitter (E3 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Level measurements (E3 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Receiver (DS3 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Transmitter (DS3 circuits). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Physical measurements (DS3 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Receiver (STS-1 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Transmitter (STS-1 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
x 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Contents

Physical measurements (STS-1 circuits). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137


E4/STM-1e specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Receiver (E4 circuits). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Transmitter (E4 circuits). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Physical measurements (E4 circuits). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Receiver (STM-1e circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Transmitter (STM-1e circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Physical measurements (STM-1e circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
SFP/SFP+ specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Supported optical rates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Optical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
MSAM specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Physical specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Power supply specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Battery specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
HS Datacom PIM specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Clock input interface specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Clock output interface specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Internal synthesizer specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
X.21 interface specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
RS-232/V.24 interface specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
EIA-530/EIA-530A balanced interface specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
EIA-530/EIA-530A unbalanced interface specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
MIL-188c interface specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
V.35 interface specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
MIL-188-114 interface specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Diphase PIM specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
DS1 PIM specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Physical measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
E1 (BNC) PIM specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Receiver (BNC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Transmitter (BNC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
E1 (RJ-48) PIM specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Receiver (RJ-48) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Transmitter (RJ-48) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
E3/DS3/STS-1 PIM specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Receiver (E3 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Transmitter (E3 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Level measurements (E3 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Receiver (DS3 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Transmitter (DS3 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Physical measurements (DS3 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Receiver (STS-1 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Transmitter (STS-1 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Physical measurements (STS-1 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
E4/STM-1e PIM specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Receiver (E4 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Transmitter (E4 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Physical measurements (E4 circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Receiver (STM-1e circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Transmitter (STM-1e circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Physical measurements (STM-1e circuits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 xi
Contents

Interface Specifications- Jitter and Wander applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171


SFP PIM specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Supported electrical rates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Electrical interface specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Supported optical rates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
XFP PIM specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Supported optical rates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Optical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Clock source (Timing) specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Transport Module specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
Physical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
Power supply specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Battery specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Electrical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
DS1 electrical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Receivers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Transmitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Physical measurements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
E1 (2M) electrical specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Receivers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Transmitters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
E3 electrical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Transmitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Level measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
DS3 electrical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Receivers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Transmitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Physical measurements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
STS-1 electrical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Receivers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Transmitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Physical measurements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
E4 electrical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Transmitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Physical measurements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
STM-1 electrical specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Transmitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Physical measurements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
10/100/1000Base T electrical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Optical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Interface specifications- Jitter and Wander applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Interface specifications- Non-Jitter and Wander applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Jitter and Wander specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Electrical jitter and wander specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Standards. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Jitter generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Jitter analyzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Automatic jitter measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Wander generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Wander measurement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
xii 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Contents

Memory requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192


Interface specifications (Jitter and Wander applications) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Optical jitter and wander specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Standards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Jitter generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Jitter analyzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Automatic jitter measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Wander generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
Wander measurement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Memory requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
40G/100G Transport Module specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Physical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Power Supply Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Battery Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Optical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
CFP Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
QSFP+ Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
CSAM specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Physical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Power Supply Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Battery Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Optical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
CFP2 Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
QSFP+ Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
SFP+ Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
DMC specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Physical specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Power supply specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Battery specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Transceiver specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Environmental specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
T-BERD / MTS 5800 Environmental specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
MSAM Environmental Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
Transport Module Environmental Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206

Appendix B Storage and Shipment 207


Storing the instrument. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Environmental specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Other environmental limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Shipping the your instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Removing the component . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Packing the components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Returning equipment to JDSU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 xiii
Contents

Appendix C Customer Services and Support 211


About our services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Standard support services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Instrument repair and calibration services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Technical assistance (business hour) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Warranty information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Product documentation library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Add-on services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Extended product and systems support services. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Professional and consulting services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Managed services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Training options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214

Glossary 215

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
xiv 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
About this Manual

This preface explains how to use this Getting Started manual. Topics discussed in this chapter
include the following:

– “Purpose and scope” on page xvi


– “Assumptions” on page xvi
– “Terminology” on page xvi
– “Getting Started Manual” on page xx
– “Conventions” on page xx
– “Safety and compliance information” on page xxi
– “Technical assistance” on page xxii

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 xv
About this Manual
Purpose and scope

Purpose and scope


The purpose of this manual is to help you successfully use the features and capabilities of the Dual
Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM for the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800 plat-
forms as well as each of the members of the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 Handheld Network Test Family.

This manual includes task-based instructions that describe how to configure, use, and troubleshoot
the general functions of the Transport Module, MSAM (Multiple Services Application Module), and
T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800. Additionally, this manual provides a complete description of JDSU warranty,
services, and repair information. For terms and conditions of the licensing agreement, go to go to
www.jdsu.com.

Assumptions
This manual is intended for novice, intermediate, and experienced users who want to use the Dual
Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM effectively and efficiently. We are assuming that you
have basic computer experience and are familiar with basic telecommunication concepts, termi-
nology, and safety.

Terminology
The T-BERD 8000 is branded as the MTS-8000 in Europe, and it is interchangeably referred to as
the T-BERD 8000, MTS 8000, MTS-8000, MTS8000 and Media Test Set 8000 throughout
supporting documentation.

The T-BERD 6000A is branded as the MTS-6000A in Europe, and it is interchangeably referred to
as the T-BERD 6000A, MTS 6000A, MTS-6000A, MTS6000A and Media Test Set 6000A
throughout supporting documentation.

The T-BERD 5800 is branded as the MTS-5800 in Europe, and it is interchangeably referred to as
the T-BERD 5800, MTS 5800, MTS-5800, MTS5800 and Media Test Set 5800 throughout
supporting documentation.

The following terms have a specific meaning when they are used in this manual:

– Assembly — Used throughout this manual to refer to a complete set of components assem-
bled as an instrument and used for testing. This manual supports three assemblies:
– 40/100G Transport Module assembly, consisting of an T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit and
40/100G Transport Module
– CSAM assembly, consisting of a CSAM and either a DMCv2 or 6000Av2 base unit.
– MSAM assembly, consisting of a MSAM, Physical Interface Modules (PIMs), and a
T-BERD ⁄ MTS 6000A base unit
– DMC assembly, consisting of up to two MSAMs, up to four PIMs, a Dual Module Carrier
(DMC), and a T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit.
– Application module — Used throughout this manual to refer to the component that provides
test functionality to the assembled instrument. This manual supports three application
modules: the MSAM, CSAM, and the 40/100G Transport Module.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
xvi 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
About this Manual
Terminology

– Component— Used throughout this manual to refer to an individual hardware component


which is connected to the other components to build a test instrument (assembly). This
manual supports the following components: the Transport Module, 40/100G Transport
Module, the MSAM, and the DMC. The base units are documented in separate manuals.
– T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800 — The family of products, typically a combination of a
base unit, a battery module, and one or more application modules. The Dual Module Carrier
(DMC) can be used on the T-BERD / MTS 8000 platform to test using two MSAMs.
– Base unit — The unit which connects to the application module and power adapter, providing
the user interface and a variety of connectivity and work flow tools. If optioned to do so, the
base unit also allows you to measure emitted power, received power, and optical link loss on
fiber optic networks.
– DMC — Dual Module Carrier. The DMC is a two slot chassis which you can connect to the
T-BERD / MTS 8000 base unit to test using up to two CSAMs (with DMCv2) or two MSAM
application modules and four Physical Interface Modules (PIMs).
– MSAM Multiple Services Application Module — Referred to generically as “the instrument”
when inserted in the T-BERD / MTS 6000A base unit or the DMC with a PIM. The MSAM
provides testing functionality for the base unit.
– PIM — The physical interface module inserted into one of up to two ports provided on the
MSAM chassis. PIMs supply the physical connectors (interfaces) required to connect the
MSAM to the circuit under test. A variety of cables, SFPs, and XFPs are offered as options,
and can be used to connect the PIMs to the circuit.
– Transport Module — Referred to generically as “the instrument” when connected to the
T-BERD / MTS 8000 base unit. The Transport Module provides testing functionality for the
base unit.
– 40/100G Transport Module — Referred to generically as “the instrument” when connected
to the T-BERD / MTS 8000 base unit. The 40/100G Transport Module provides testing func-
tionality for the base unit.
– Battery Module — The module connected to the back of the T-BERD / MTS 8000 base unit,
which supplies power whenever it is not provided using the power adapter.
– OC-n — Used to refer to each of the optical SONET rates supported by the Transport Module
or MSAM (OC-3, OC-12, OC-48, and OC-192), where “n” represents the user-selected line
rate.
– STM-n — Used to refer to each of the optical SDH rates supported by the Transport Module
or MSAM (STM-1, STM-4, STM-16, and STM-64), where “n” represents the user-selected line
rate.
– STS-1 — Used to refer to the electrical equivalent of OC-1 (51.84 Mbps) supported by the
Transport Module or MSAM.
– STM-1e — Used to refer to the electrical equivalent of STM-1 (155.52 Mbps) supported by
the Transport Module or MSAM.
– OTN — Optical Transport Network.
– OTU1 — Optical Transport Unit 1. A 2.7G OTN signal designed to carry a SONET OC-48 or
SDH STM-16 client signal. OTU1 is used on the Transport Module connector panel and the
Transport Module and MSAM user interfaces to identify the connectors and applications used
for 2.7G OTN testing.
– OTU2 — Optical Transport Unit 2. A 10.7G, 11.05G, or 11.1G OTN signal designed to carry
SONET OC-192, SDH STM-64, or 10GigE Ethernet WAN and LAN client signals. OTU2 is
used on the Transport Module connector panel and the Transport Module and MSAM user
interfaces to identify the connectors and applications used for 10.7G, 11.05G, or 11.1G OTN
testing.
– OTU3 — Optical transport Unit 3. A 43G OTN signal designed to carry 40Gig BERT signals.
OTU3 is available on the CSAM and the 40/100G High Speed Transport Module.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 xvii
About this Manual
Terminology

– OTU4 — Optical transport Unit 4. A 111.8G OTN signal designed to carry 100Gig Ethernet
BERT and ODU4 encoded signals. OTU4 is available on the CSAM and 40/100G High Speed
Transport Module.
– 10/100/1000 Ethernet — Used to represent 10/100/1000 Mbps Ethernet. The connector
panel also uses 10/100/1000M to identify the connector used for 10/100/1000 Mbps Ethernet
testing.
– 1GigE — Used to represent 1 Gigabit Ethernet. The Transport Module connector panel also
uses GigE to identify the optical connector used for 1 Gigabit Ethernet testing.
– 10GigE — Used to represent 10 Gigabit Ethernet. The Transport Module connector panel
also uses 10GE and 10G to identify the optical connectors used for 10 Gigabit Ethernet LAN
and WAN testing.
– 100GigE — Used to represent 100 Gigabit Ethernet. The 40G/100G High Speed Transport
Module connector panel also uses 100GE and 100G to identify the optical connectors used
for 100 Gigabit Ethernet testing.
– SyncE — Synchronous Ethernet.
– FC — Used to represent Fibre Channel on the Transport Module connector panel and the
Transport Module and MSAM user interface to identify the optical connectors used for
Fibre Channel testing.
– JDSU Ethernet test set — A test set marketed by JDSU and designed to transmit an
Acterna Test Packet (ATP) payload. These packets carry a time stamp used to calculate a
variety of test results. The FST-2802 TestPad, the SmartClass Ethernet tester, the HST with
an Ethernet SIM, the T-BERD/MTS 8000 Transport Module, the T-BERD/MTS 6000A MSAM,
and the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 can all be configured to transmit and analyze ATP payloads, and
can be used in end-to-end and loopback configurations during testing.
– SFP — Small Form-factor Pluggable module. Used on the connector panel and throughout
this manual to represent pluggable optical modules.

Figure 1 SFP PIM and SFP transceivers

– SFP+ — Enhanced Small Form-Factor Pluggable module. This enhanced version of the SFP
module can support data rates up to 10Gb.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
xviii 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
About this Manual
Terminology

– XFP — 10 Gigabit Small Form-Factor Pluggable optical transceiver. A variety of optional


XFPs are available for testing 10 Gigabit fiber circuits.

Figure 2 XFP PIM and XFP transceiver

– QSFP+ — Quad Small Form-Factor Pluggable optical transceiver. A variety of optional


QSFP+s are available for testing 40 Gigabit fiber circuits.

Figure 3 QSFP+ transceiver

– CFP — C Form-Factor Pluggable optical transceiver. A variety of optional CFPs are available
for testing 40G and/or 100GB fiber circuits and out-of-circuit testing of the instrument.

Figure 4 CFP transceiver

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 xix
About this Manual
Getting Started Manual

Getting Started Manual


This is the getting started manual for the Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM. It
provides basic instructions for assembling the instrument components, setting up the
Transport Module or MSAM, instrument specifications, and contact information for JDSU Technical
Assistance Center (TAC). Read this manual carefully before connecting your instrument to the
circuit you are testing.

Use this manual in conjunction with the following manuals:

– The 8000 Base Unit User Manual. This manual provides an overview, specifications, and
instructions for proper operation of the 8000 base unit. The40G/100G High Speed Transport
Module uses the 8000E Base unit.
– The 6000A Base Unit User Manual. This manual provides an overview, specifications, and
instructions for proper operation of the 6000A base unit.
– The Ethernet, IP, TCP/UDP, Fibre Channel, and IP Video Testing Manual for the
T-BERD 5800, MSAM, CSAM, and 40/100G Transport Module. The manual provides detailed
instructions for testing on each of the listed networks. It also explains how to run key scripts
and describes each of the available test results.
– The PDH, SONET, SDH, NextGen, and OTN Testing Manual for the T-BERD 5800, MSAM,
CSAM, and 40/100G Transport Module. The manual provides detailed instructions for testing
on each of the listed networks.
– The Data Communications and Diphase Testing Manual for the MSAM. The manual provides
detailed instructions for testing Datacom and Diphase interfaces using the MSAM.
– Help. The topics addressed in the testing manuals are also available on your instrument in an
HTML format.

Conventions
This manual uses conventions and symbols, as described in the following tables.

Table 1 Typographical conventions


Description Example

User interface actions and buttons or switches you have Press the OK key.
to press appear in this typeface.

Code and output messages appear in this typeface. All results okay

Text you must type exactly as shown appears in this Type: a:\set.exe in the dialog box.
typeface.

Variables appear in this typeface. Type the new hostname.

Book references appear in this typeface. Refer to Newton’s Telecom Dictionary

Table 2 Keyboard and menu conventions


Description Example

A plus sign + indicates simultaneous keystrokes. Press Ctrl+s

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
xx 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
About this Manual
Safety and compliance information

Table 2 Keyboard and menu conventions (Continued)


Description Example

A comma indicates consecutive key strokes. Press Alt+f,s

A slanted bracket indicates choosing a submenu from On the menu bar, click
menu. Start > Program Files.

Table 3 Symbol conventions

This symbol represents a general hazard.

This symbol represents a risk of electrical shock.

This symbol represents a risk of explosion.

This symbol represents a Note indicating related information or tip.

This symbol, located on the equipment, battery, or packaging indicates that the equipment or
battery must not be disposed of in a land-fill site or as municipal waste, and should be disposed
of according to your national regulations.

Table 4 Safety definitions

WARNING
Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious
injury.

CAUTION
Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, may result in minor or moderate
injury.

Safety and compliance information


Safety and compliance information for the instrument are provided in printed form and ship with your
instrument.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 xxi
About this Manual
Technical assistance

Since the MSAM, CSAM, and 40/100G Transport Module are part of a modular platform, the safety
and compliance information are available with the base unit in the Base-Unit User manual (deliv-
ered in the equipment’s help system), with some additional information in the printed card T-BERD/
MTS-6000 Getting Started Manual or T-BERD/MTS-8000 Getting Started Manual, provided with the
base unit.

For the 5800, refer to the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 Safety Information document that shipped with the
instrument.

Technical assistance
If you need assistance or have questions related to the use of this product, call or e-mail JDSU
Technical Assistance Center (TAC) for customer support. TAC phone numbers and email
addresses are listed in Table 5 on page xxii.

Table 5 lists contact information for technical assistance. For the latest TAC information, go to
www.jdsu.com or contact your local sales office for assistance. Contact information for regional
sales headquarters is listed on the back cover of this manual.

Table 5 Technical assistance centers


Region Phone Number

Americas 1-855-ASK-JDSU [email protected]


1-301-353-1560

Europe, Africa, and Mid-East +49 (0) 7121 86 1345 [email protected]


(JDSU Germany)

Asia and the Pacific +852 2892 0990


(Hong Kong)

+86 10 6655 5988


(Beijing-China)

During off-hours, you can request assistance by doing one of the following: leave a voice mail
message at the Technical Assistance number, e-mail the North American Technical Assistance
Center, [email protected], or submit your question using our online Technical Assistance Request form
at www.jdsu.com.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
xxii 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
1
Chapter 1 Overview

This chapter provides a general description of the Transport Module,CSAM, and MSAM application
modules, the Dual Module Carrier (DMC), and the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800. Topics discussed in this
chapter include the following:

– “About the instruments” on page 2


– “Features and capabilities” on page 2
– “Configuring your instrument” on page 4
– “Configuring your instrument” on page 4
– “What ships with your instrument?” on page 4
– “Accessories” on page 6
– “About the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800” on page 7
– “About the Transport Module Assembly” on page 12
– “About the CSAM Assembly” on page 19
– “About the MSAM Assembly” on page 22
– “About the DMC Assembly” on page 27
– “JDSU recommended SFPs and XFPs” on page 30

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 1
Chapter 1 Overview
About the instruments

About the instruments


The Transport Module, MSAM, and T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 are all in one test solutions for the
following networks:

– T-Carrier (DS1 and DS3)


– PDH (E1 through E4)
– SONET (STS-1 through OC-192)
– SDH (STM-1e through STM-64)
– Ethernet (10/100/1000, 100 M Optical, 1 Gigabit Optical, 10 Gigabit Ethernet LAN and WAN,
40 Gigabit Optical and 100 Gigabit Optical)
– IP (10/100/1000, 100 M Optical, 1 Gigabit Optical, 10 Gigabit Ethernet LAN and WAN,
40 Gigabit Optical and 100 Gigabit Optical.
– TCP/UDP (10/100/1000, 100 M Optical, 1 Gigabit Optical, and10 Gigabit Ethernet LAN)
– IP Video (10/100/1000, 100 M Optical, 1 Gigabit Optical, and 10 Gigabit Ethernet LAN)
– Fibre Channel (1G, 2G, 4G, 8 G, and 10G)
(8G available only on MSAMv2 with 8G-capable SFP+ or XFP transceiver)
– OTN (2.7G, 10.7G, 11.05G, 11.1G, 43.02G and 111.8G)
The MSAM also accepts physical interface modules (PIMs) designed to allow you to test Data
communications and Diphase interfaces.

They are designed to be rugged, portable, battery-operated test solutions that facilitate the quick
turn-up and troubleshooting of multiple services and network elements in the Metro and Core
network. This allows providers who are expanding their offerings into new data and wavelength
services to deploy a single technician to install and maintain new elements and services using one
integrated module or integrated instrument.

Features and capabilities


Features and capabilities of the Transport Module, MSAM, and 5800 include the following
(assuming your instrument is optioned and configured to support the features):

– Electrical interface support — Ability to test circuits from a variety of electrical interfaces (DS1,
E1 BNC, E1 RJ-48, E3, DS3, STS-1, E4, and STM-1e).
– SONET/SDH interface support — Ability to test circuits from a variety of SONET and SDH
interfaces (OC-3/STM-1 through OC-192/STM-64 interfaces).
– Ethernet interface support — Ability to test circuits from a variety of Ethernet interfaces (10/
100/1000 Mbps Electrical through 100M and1 GigE optical circuits), and 10 GigE LAN and
WAN, and 100 GigE optical circuits at 850 nm, 1310 nm, and 1550 nm.
– SyncE interface support — Ability to test circuits from a variety of SyncE interfaces (10/100/
1000 Mbps Electrical).
– Fibre Channel interface support — Ability to test 1 Gigabit, 2 Gigabit, 4 Gigabit, and 8 Gigabit
Fibre Channel interfaces.
– OTN support — Ability to test OTU1 (2.7G) and OTU2 (10.7G, 11.05G, and 11.1G) circuits by
performing FEC tests, BER tests, and inserting errors and alarms. Also test OTU3 (43.02G)
and OTU4 (111.8G) circuits by performing BERT and Ethernet tests and inserting errors and
alarms. All tests are to verify that network performance conforms to G.709 standards.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
2 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
Features and capabilities

– Intuitive user interface — User interface facilitates quick test configuration and execution, and
easy interpretation of test results.
– Detailed test results — You can use the entire screen to observe test results, or you can
collapse and expand certain test results for which a variety of measurements are made (such
as current, average, minimum, or peak throughput measurements). You can also suppress
graphical result collection if you intend to run resource intensive applications. For Dual Term or
Dual Through applications, you can observe test results for both ports simultaneously.
– Automatic traffic transmission —You can optionally set up Ethernet, IP, TCP/UDP, and Fibre
Channel test applications to generate and transmit traffic automatically whenever you turn the
laser on (for optical applications).
– VT-100 terminal emulation — If your instrument is optioned to do so, you can use it to emulate
a VT-100 terminal, and then connect it to a network element via a serial interface to gather
information about the element.
– Optical power measurements — Ability to measure optical power.
– Automated RFC 2544 and Fibre Channel tests — In addition to the standard tests, expert tests
are now available which allow you to specify and review test settings quickly and efficiently.
– HTML viewer — An HTML viewer is available which allows you to easily view and navigate
through HTML files on your instrument.
– Cable testing — Ability to examine the state of the cables used to transmit 10/100/1000 elec-
trical Ethernet signals before you begin testing.
– Ethernet and Internet Protocol service verification — Ability to verify proper installation and
maintenance of carrier-grade Ethernet and Internet Protocol services.
– IP video service verification — The ability to verify and troubleshoot IP video service.
– TCP/UDP, FTP, and HTTP protocol support — The ability to transmit and analyze traffic
carried using the TCP/UDP, FTP, and HTTP protocols.
– VLAN, Q-in-Q, VPLS, and MPLS encapsulation support — The ability to transmit and analyze
VLAN, Q-in-Q, VPLS, and MPLS encapsulated Ethernet traffic.
– Dual view applications — When running multiple tests, you can view results for two tests side-
by-side. For more information, see “Viewing both tests” on page 98.
– Support for 10G tunable XFPs — The ITU-T G.694.2 standard provides a frequency grid for
DWDM which creates channel spacing. The channel spacing allows different carriers to run on
the same fiber. When using a tunable XFP in our instrument, channel, wavelength or frequen-
cies can be specified. If the tunable XFP uses a specification unit other than that specified in
the interface, an automatic best-match calculation will be made to select the appropriate
value. For more information, see “Tuning XFPs” on page 72.
– VNC password — Allows changing of the password on the instrument. The ability to use a
password was enhanced to allow changing of the password. On the System Setup menu, set
Remote screen to Permanent with password to use the default password, or use the
Change Password soft key specify a new password. For more information, refer to the 8000
Base Unit User Manual or the 6000A Base Unit User Manual.
Test options must be purchased and installed for some features such as IP Video testing, VPLS and
MPLS encapsulated traffic, and layer 4 TCP/UDP testing.

For a comprehensive list of features and capabilities for each technology supported, refer to the
Testing Manual that shipped with your instrument.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 3
Chapter 1 Overview
Configuring your instrument

Configuring your instrument


Each instrument is factory-configured to meet your unique testing requirements. When you place
an order for a T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800, 40/100G Transport Module, MSAM, CSAM, or DMC, a
customer service or sales representative will help you determine which chassis, optics assembly,
connector configuration, PIMs, or testing options your module needs to test the following:

– Optical 100M, GigE, 10 GigE LAN and WAN PHY circuits, 40G and 100G using 850 nm, 1310
nm, and 1550 nm wavelength signals
– Ethernet and IP traffic over 10/100/1000 Mbps electrical circuits.
– SyncE traffic over 10/100/1000 Mbps electrical circuits.
– Circuits carrying VLAN, Q-in-Q, VPLS, and MPLS encapsulated traffic.
– TCP/UDP traffic carried on 10/100/1000, 100 M Optical, 1 Gigabit Optical, and
10 Gigabit Ethernet circuits
– IP Video traffic carried on 10/100/1000, 100 M Optical, 1 Gigabit Optical, and
10 Gigabit Ethernet circuits.
– 1 Gigabit, 2 Gigabit, 4 Gigabit, 8 Gigabit and 10 Gigabit Fibre Channel networks, including
FICON support for Storage Area Networks
– Optical SONET and SDH circuits at 155 Mbps, 622 Mbps, 40 Gbps, 2.5 Gbps, and 10 Gbps
line rates
– OTN circuits at 2.7 Gbps, 10.7 Gbps, 11.05 Gbps, 11.09 Gbps, 43.02Gbps, and 111.8Gbps
line rates
– T-carrier and PDH circuits with DS1, E1, E3, DS3, and E4 interfaces and payload mappings
– Data communications and Diphase interfaces
– Jitter and wander on DS1, E1, E3, DS3, E4, STM-1 electrical circuits, and 155 Mbps, 622
Mbps, 2.5 Gbps, and 2.7 Gbps optical circuits per ITU-T Recommendations O.172 and O.173.
NOTE: Optical jitter and wander are only supported by the Transport Module with a
10 cm chassis.
To discuss a specific hardware chassis, configuration, or the available testing options, contact your
regional sales office. Contact information for regional sales headquarters is provided on the back
cover of this manual.

What ships with your instrument?


The following items typically ship with your instrument:

– Base unit, application modules, and DMC — Depending on your order, the components
required to test network elements and services are shipped to you. Components may include
the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit, the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 6000A base unit, the DMC (Dual
Module Carrier), the Transport Module, and the MSAM. Software and hardware options are
also available which enable you to expand your testing capabilities for T-Carrier/PDH,
SONET/SDH, Ethernet, IP, TCP/UDP, IP Video, Fibre Channel, and OTN testing.
The T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 is factory-configured to meet your testing requirements (see Table 2
on page 7).
– Physical interface module (PIM) — Each MSAM provides up to two PIM slots, enabling you to
connect and swap a variety of PIMs designed to test specific interfaces. After you select the
MSAM chassis that best suits your needs, your customer service representative will let you
know which PIMs are available for that particular chassis.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
4 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
Unpacking the components

– SFPs/SFP+s/XFPs — When you order a PIM, a customer service representative will let you
know which transceivers are available from JDSU. Additional transceivers can be ordered
separately for an additional charge.
– Power adapter — A power adapter designed specifically for use with the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800,
Transport Module, MSAM, CSAM, or DMC is included. Use only the JDSU Power Adapter that
shipped with your particular instrument. For details, refer to “Powering the instrument” on
page 52.
– Fiber Optic connectors — If your Module is configured for 10 Gigabit testing, one set of SC,
FC, or ST fiber optic connectors is included with the module. When you order your module, a
customer service representative will ask you which type of connectors (SC, FC, or ST) you
would like.
The 40/100G Module and the CSAM can be used with CFP or CFP2 optics (40/100G rates) or
QSFP+ optics (40G rates). For single-mode interfaces, such as 100GBASE-LR4 or
40GBASE-LR4, the typical connector type used on the optics which JDSU provides is LC.
LC connectors and SFPs are also available for some interfaces and can be ordered separately
for an additional charge.
– BNC to BNC adapter cable — If you order an instrument with SONET testing capabilities, two
BNC to BNC adapter cables are included for DS3 and STS-1 applications.
– BNC to 440A adapter cable — If you order an instrument with SONET testing capabilities, two
BNC to 440A adapter cables are included for DS3 and STS-1 applications.
– Carrying case — A carrying case is included with the Transport Module or MSAM. Always use
this carrying case when transporting your instrument, and follow the instructions provided with
the carrying case carefully.
Do not use the case designed for the T-BERD / MTS 6000 Base Unit to transport the
T-BERD / MTS 6000A and MSAM.
If you ordered an MSAM, a transceiver case designed to accommodate up to six SFPs and
three XFPs is also available. A PIM carrying case is also available, which can store up to three
PIMs.
– User documentation — A Getting Started Manual and Testing Manuals (on USB memory
stick), a list of JDSU recommended optics (SFP transceivers), and a comprehensive help
system also ship with the instrument. Remote control command documentation is also avail-
able on the documentation USB memory stick.
Before testing, the application modules (and if applicable, the DMC) must be connected to a base
unit, which can be ordered separately. Refer to the 8000 Base Unit User Manual or the 6000A Base
Unit User Manual for a list of options and accessories offered for the base units.

Unpacking the components


JDSU typically ships the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800, Transport Module, MSAM, CSAM, or DMC using
anti-static packing material to stabilize the components inside the box.

When unpacking the components, verify that all the items you ordered are included in the package.
Accessories may be shipped in a separate box.

After you unpack the components, you should inspect them for damage.

If undamaged, consider saving the box and packing materials in case you need to repackage the
components for shipment. For information about shipping equipment, see Appendix B “Storage
and Shipment” .

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 5
Chapter 1 Overview
Inspecting the components for damage

Inspecting the components for damage


After you unpack the components, examine the connectors, ports, LEDs, and screen for damage.
Be sure to check the top, bottom, and front panels.

If you find damage, contact JDSU Customer Care at 1-866-228-3762 or at www.jdsu.com.


For information about returning equipment, see “Returning equipment to JDSU” on page 209.

Accessories
Table 1 lists some of the accessories available for the Transport Module and MSAM.

Table 1 Accessories
Accessory Description

Transceivers A variety of JDSU recommended SFP, SFP+, XFP, QSFP+, CFP, and CFP2
transceivers are available for testing optical circuits. Be certain to only use JDSU
recommended transceivers with your test instrument. Each of the SFPs offered
by JDSU as an accessory is MSA compliant, and has been qualified for use with
the MSAM, CSAM, T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800, or Transport Module. A list of JDSU
recommended optics shipped with your instrument or upgrade kit.
For a list of currently supported optics (SFPs, SFP+s, XFPs, QSFP+s, CFPs,
and CFP2s), contact your JDSU TAC representative or your local JDSU sales
office. Please refer to your SFP manufacturer’s site for detailed transceiver spec-
ifications.

Cables A variety of JDSU-recommended optical cables are available for connecting to


the circuit you are testing.

Attenuators A variety of JDSU-recommended attenuators are available for attenuating trans-


mitted and received signals if necessary.

Rack Mount This kit allows you to mount the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit with a Transport
Module in a 19 inch rack.

Hard case A hard case is available which allows you to protect your Transport Module when
not in use. Cases are designed to hold a single T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit
with a single 4 cm, 5 cm, 7 cm, or 10 cm Transport Module and a battery module.

Soft case Light weight cases allow you to store your test instrument when not in use.
The Transport Module cases are designed to hold a single base unit with a single
5 cm or 10 cm application module and a battery module.
The MSAM cases are designed to hold a single base unit with a single MSAM. A
PIM carrying case is also available, which can store up to three PIMs.
In addition to the MSAM and PIM cases, a transceiver case designed to accom-
modate up to six SFPs and three XFPs is available.

Refer to the 8000 Base Unit User Manual or 6000A Base Unit User Manual for a list of accessories
offered for the base unit.

NOTE:
For additional information about T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800 MSAM or
Transport Module configurations, options, and services, contact your local JDSU representative
or contact JDSU via the company web site, www.jdsu.com.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
6 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
About the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800

About the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800


The T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 family of testers, shown in Figure 1 is designed to be a rugged, portable,
battery-operated test solution that facilitates the quick turn-up and troubleshooting of multiple
services and network elements in the Metro and Core network. This allows providers who are
expanding their offerings into new data and wavelength services to deploy a single technician to
install and maintain new elements and services using one integrated instrument.

Figure 1 T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800

Configuring the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800


The T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 is factory-configured to meet your testing requirements.

When you place an order for a T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800, a customer service or sales representative will
help you determine the right configuration for your needs.

Table 2 describes the available configurations.

Table 2 T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 configurations


Catalog Number Configuration

TB/MTS-5801 T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 Single Port Test set

TB/MTS-5802 T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 Dual Port Test set

TB/MTS-5812 T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 10G and Dual Port Test set

TB/MTS-5812LB T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 10G and Dual Port Loop back device
(loop back applications only, no traffic generation)
TB/MTS-5801P T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 Single Port Test set with PDH

TB/MTS-5802P T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 Dual Port Test set with PDH

TB/MTS-5812P T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 10G and Dual Port Test set with PDH

TB/MTS-5811P T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 V2 Single 10G with PDH (including E3/DS3)

TB/MTS-5811PL T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 V2 Single 10G with PDH

TB/MTS-5822P T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 V2 Dual 10G with PDH

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 7
Chapter 1 Overview
About the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800

NOTE:
Some configurations also require you to purchase and install certain testing options; others
require specific hardware connectors to connect to circuits for testing. For example, if your
instrument does not have a connector designed to support 1GigE Optical testing, you can not
transmit and analyze a signal or traffic over a 1GigE circuit.
You can quickly determine whether or not your instrument supports certain applications by
exploring the technologies, rates, and test modes presented on the Test menu and by reviewing
the settings available when you configure a test.

To discuss a specific configuration or to order accessories for your T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800, contact
JDSU Customer Care or your regional sales office. Contact information for regional sales headquar-
ters is provided on the back cover of this manual. You can also contact JDSU through the company
web site, www.jdsu.com.

Exploring the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800


The connector panel of the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 provides the internal connectors and SFP+
connectors used to connect the instrument to the circuit for testing. After selecting a test application,
LEDs illuminate indicating which connectors to use for your test.

A variety of hardware configurations are available for the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800; therefore, your unit
may not have all of the connectors in Figure 2. This figure illustrates the configuration T-BERD/MTS
5822P - T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 V2 10G Dual Port Test set with PDH. Refer to Appendix A “Specifi-
cations” for detailed connector specifications.

Figure 2 Connector panel, top of T-BERD/MTS 5822P

SFP+ connectors
Two SFP+ connectors allow you to connect the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 to a SONET, SDH,
1 Gigabit Ethernet, 10GigE, 100 FX, or 100M Ethernet circuit to transmit and then analyze traffic.

E3/DS3/STS-1/E4/STM1(e) connectors
One Tx/Rx pair or two receivers allow you to connect the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 to an E3, DS3, STS-
1, E4, or STM-1e circuit to transmit and analyze traffic.

10/100/1000M connectors
Up to two 10/100/1000M connectors allow you to connect the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 to an electrical
Ethernet circuit to transmit and analyze traffic.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
8 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
About the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800

E1 connectors
Two unbalanced 75 BNC receivers, and one unbalanced BNC transmitter allow you to
connect the instrument to an E1 (2M) circuit to transmit and analyze traffic. The Rx 2 receiver can
be used as the input for a SETS signal or an E1 reference clock.

E1 RJ 48 transmitter/receiver
One balanced 120 RJ 48 transmitter/receiver allows you to connect the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 to
an E1 (2M) circuit to transmit and analyze traffic.

NOTE:
The E1 and DS1 interfaces should not be connected at the same time. After running your test,
disconnect from one interface before connecting to the other interface.

DS1 connectors
Two DS1 Bantam receivers and one DS1 Bantam transmitter allow you to connect the
T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 to a DS1 circuit to transmit and analyze traffic. The Rx 2 receiver can be used
as the input for a DS1 BITS signal.

EXT CLK connector


SMA connector for external clock input. Use the SMA to BNC barrel adaptor if a BNC connector is
needed.

Headset/handset connector
Use the headset connector when dropping voice traffic from a DS0 interface.

USB host connector


Located on the right side of the unit, the two USB host connectors (USB 2.0) allow connection of a
USB drive, or other USB device.

LAN connector
Located on the right side of the unit, the RJ-45 LAN connector is used to connect to your local
network.

Attaching a module to the 5800


If you have a module (such as an OTDR module) for your T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800, this procedure
describes how to attach it.

NOTE:
The following OTDR modules can be attached to the MTS 5800:
E4126LA, E4126MA, E4136MA, E4136RMA, E4146QUAD

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 9
Chapter 1 Overview
About the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800

To attach a module to the 5800


1 Power down off the 5800 and disconnect the AC adapter.
2 Remove the four screws that hold the back cover in place.

3 Lift off the back cover to expose the connector.

4 Notice the hinges on the module.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
10 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
About the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800

5 Insert the module hinges into the 5800 at about a 45 to 60 degree angle.

6 Pivot the module down towards the connector.

7 Seat the module into the connector with slight pressure.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 11
Chapter 1 Overview
About the Transport Module Assembly

8 Tighten the screws on the module.

9 Power up the 5800. Menus related to the module are now available.

About the Transport Module Assembly


The Transport Module is used in combination with the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit and a battery
pack.

Figure 3 T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 with a Transport Module graphical user interface

Three types of Transport Module chassis are available:

– A standard 5 cm chassis.
– An expanded 10 cm chassis, for 10G and below applications, which is required if you intend to
use your module for optical jitter and wander testing. O.172 MTIE/TDEV Offline Analysis soft-
ware is also included if you order this chassis.
– A high speed 10 cm chassis for 40G and 100G applications. This module has ports that accept
QSFP+ and CFP transceivers.
A variety of hardware configurations are also available for each Transport Module.

For assembly instructions, see “Connecting a Transport Module or DMC to a base unit” on page 32.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
12 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
About the Transport Module Assembly

Determining your chassis version


You can easily determine your chassis version by looking at the label on the lower left corner of the
connector panel. Figure 4 shows the version label for a version 3 5 cm chassis.

Version 3 Label

Figure 4 Version 3 Label (5 cm chassis)

Chassis requirements
Table 3 lists the chassis requirements for each of the circuits and applications supported by the
Transport Module and CSAM. All dual port applications require two connectors on the panel.

Table 3 Chassis requirements


Circuits/Applications Requirements

T-Carrier and PDH Any 5 cm or 10 cm chassis with the appropriate electrical connectors
and test options. (excluding 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module)

SONET and SDH Any 5 cm or 10 cm chassis with the appropriate optical connectors (or
SFP connectors) and test options.

Ethernet, IP, and TCP/UDP Any 5 cm or 10 cm chassis with the appropriate connectors (or SFP
(except 40G and 100G) connectors) and test options for the circuit.
For example, if you want to use your module to transmit multiple
streams of traffic over a 10 GigE WAN circuit, your chassis must have a
10 GigE (or 10G) connector, and the 10 GigE WAN and Multiple
Streams test options are required.

Ethernet - 40G and 100G 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module or CSAM

IP Video Any 5 cm or 10 cm chassis (excluding 40G/100G High Speed Transport


Module) with the appropriate connectors (or SFP connectors) and test
options for the circuit.
For example, if you want to use your module analyze IP Video traffic on
a 10 GigE LAN circuit, your chassis must have a 10 GigE (or 10G) con-
nector, and the IP Video test option is required.

1 Gigabit and 2 Gigabit Fibre Any 5 cm or 10 cm chassis (excluding 40G/100G High Speed Transport
Channel Module) with the appropriate connectors and test options for the circuit.

4 Gigabit Fibre Channel A V3 5 cm or 10 cm chassis (excluding 40G/100G High Speed Trans-


port Module). The 4 Gigabit Fibre Channel test option is also required.

10 Gigabit Fibre Channel A V2 or higher 5 cm chassis, or any 10 cm chassis with a 10 Gigabit


connector. The 10 Gigabit Fibre Channel test option is also required.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 13
Chapter 1 Overview
About the Transport Module Assembly

Table 3 Chassis requirements (Continued)


Circuits/Applications Requirements

Electrical DS1 and DS3 Jitter Any 5 cm or 10 cm chassis with the appropriate DS1 and DS3 connec-
tors. The DS1/DS3 Jitter test option is also required.

Electrical Jitter and Wander A V2 or higher 5 cm chassis, or any 10 cm chassis with the appropriate
Testing (all rates) electrical connectors. The Electrical Jitter and Wander test option is also
required.

Optical Jitter and Wander Any 10 cm chassis with 10 Gigabit connectors. The Optical Jitter and
Wander test options are also required.

OTN carrying SONET, SDH, A V2 or higher 5 cm chassis, or any 10 cm chassis (excluding 40G/
Ethernet, or Bulk BERT pay- 100G High Speed Transport Module). Both chassis must be configured
loads at OTU1 and OTU2 with a FEM board and a 10 Gigabit connector. The OTN (ATO) test
rates option is also required.

OTN carrying BERT pay- 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module or CSAM
loads at OTU3 and Ethernet
or Bulk payloads at OTU4
rates

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
14 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
About the Transport Module Assembly

The connector panel of the Transport Module provides the provides the internal connectors and
SFP connectors used to connect the module to the circuit for testing.
On the Transport Module, after selecting a test application, LEDs illuminate indicating which
connectors to use for your test.

A variety of hardware configurations are available for the Transport Module; therefore, your unit
may not have all of the connectors in Figure 5 on page 15, Figure 6 on page 16 or Figure 7 on
page 17. These figures illustrate the 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module, the standard Version
3 5 cm chassis and the expanded Version 3 10 cm chassis configured with every currently available
connector. Refer to Appendix A “Specifications” for detailed connector specifications.

NOTE:
Some Transport Modules with internal optical connectors provide separate, independent trans-
mit connectors for 1550 nm and 1310 nm; others provide transmit connectors that can support
both 1550 nm and 1310 nm signals. The labels on your connector panel indicate whether each
transmit connector operates independently (as 1550 nm or 1310 nm), or can support both sig-
nals (1550 nm and 1310 nm).

USB connector
External Reference
SMA connector

QSFP+
40G connectors

CFP
40/100G connectors

Figure 5 40/100G Transport Module Connector Panel

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 15
Chapter 1 Overview
About the Transport Module Assembly

OC-192/
STM-64/ E3/DS3/
OTU-2/ STS-1/E4/
10GigE/ STM1(e)
10G FC connectors
connectors

PORT #2
10/100/1000M
connector

PORT #2
OC3/12/48
STM-1/4/16
GigE/100FX E1 connectors
100M
1/2/4G FC
SFP connectors
E1 RJ 48
transmitter/
receiver

PORT #1
OC-3/12/48
DS1 connectors
STM-1/4/16
GigE/100FX
100M PORT #1
1/2/4G FC 10/100/1000M
OTU-1 connector
SFP connectors Audio jack
Reserved for
future use

Figure 6 5 cm chassis connector panel (Version 3, fully loaded)

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
16 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
About the Transport Module Assembly

PORT #1 PORT #1
OC-48/ OC-3/12
STM-16 STM-1/4
OTU-1 connector OTU-1 connector
(for Jitter/Wander) (for Jitter/Wander)

PORT #1
OC-192/ E3/DS3/
STM-64/ STS-1/E4/
OTU-2 STM1(e)
10GigE/ connectors
10G FC
connectors
PORT #1
PORT #2 OC-3/12/48
10/100/1000M STM-1/4/16
connector OTU-1
connectors
PORT #2
OC-3/12/48
E1
STM-1/4/16
connectors
GigE/100FX
100M
1/2/4 FC
SFP connectors E1 RJ 48
transmitter/
receiver

PORT #1 DS1
GigE/100FX connectors
100M
1/2/4G FC PORT #1
SFP connectors 10/100/1000M
connector
Audio jack
reserved for
future use

Figure 7 10 cm chassis connector panel (Version 3, fully loaded)

USB connector
Accessory connector for USB 2.0 host interface. Allows you to connect the 40G/100G High Speed
Transport Module to USB compatible memory devices and printers.

External Reference SMA connector


Connector for input/output of synchronization reference signals (BITS, SETS, 2.048MHz, 100Mhz).
Allows you to connect the 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module to external sources to obtain
synchronization timing signals.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 17
Chapter 1 Overview
About the Transport Module Assembly

QSFP+ 40G connectors


Single 40G connectors (labeled QSFP+ 40G) allow you to connect the 40G/100G High Speed
Transport Module for 40G SONET or SDH testing, 40 Gigabit Ethernet testing, or to connect to an
OTU3 (43.02G) circuit to transmit and then analyze traffic. Connector specifications are manufac-
turer dependent.

CFP 40/100G connectors


Single CFP connectors (labeled CFP 40/100G) allow you to connect the 40G/100G High Speed
Transport Module for 40G SONET or SDH testing, 40 Gigabit or 100 Gigabit Ethernet testing, or to
connect to an OTU3 (43.02 G) or OTU4 (111.8 G) circuit to transmit and then analyze traffic.

OC-192/STM-64/OTU-2/10GigE/10G FC connectors
OC-192/STM-64/OTU-2/10GigE/10G FC 1310 nm/1550 nm and 850 nm transmitters and
receivers allow you to connect the Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM to a SONET,
SDH, OTU-2 (10.7G, 11.05G, or 11.1G), 10 Gigabit Ethernet LAN or WAN, or 10 Gigabit Fibre
Channel circuit to transmit and analyze traffic. If your unit is configured and optioned to do so, you
can also analyze IP Video traffic on 10GigE LAN circuits.

The internal connectors on the panel support FC, DIN, LC, ST, and SC type optical connectors,
eliminating the need to use crossover cables, and allowing you to clean fibers easily. See Figure 8.

Figure 8 Removable Fiber Optic Connectors

NOTE:
The 850 nm transmitter and receiver are used exclusively for 10 Gigabit Ethernet LAN and
10 Gigabit Fibre Channel testing.

SFP connectors
Four SFP connectors (labeled as OC-3/12/48 STM-1/4/16 OTU-1 GigE/100FX 1/2/4 FC) allow you
to connect the Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM to a SONET, SDH,
1 Gigabit Ethernet, 100 FX, 100M, or 1, 2, or 4 Gigabit Fibre Channel circuit to transmit and then
analyze traffic. If your unit is configured and optioned to do so, you can also analyze IP Video traffic
on the Ethernet circuits. OTU-1 connections are only supported on PORT# 1.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
18 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
About the CSAM Assembly

E3/DS3/STS-1/E4/STM1(e) connectors
One transmitter and two receivers allow you to connect the Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module,
and MSAM to an E3, DS3, STS-1, E4, or STM-1e circuit to transmit and analyze traffic.

The transmitter and Rx 1 receiver can be used for all rates; the Rx 2 receiver is reserved for DS3
and STS-1 testing.

10/100/1000M connectors
Up to two 10/100/1000M connectors allow you to connect the Dual Module Carrier,
Transport Module, and MSAM to an electrical Ethernet circuit to transmit and analyze traffic.

E1 connectors
Two unbalanced 75 BNC receivers, and one unbalanced BNC transmitter allow you to
connect the module to an E1 (2M) circuit to transmit and analyze traffic. The Rx 2 receiver can be
used as the input for a SETS signal or an E1 reference clock. The E1 connector may be labeled
“2M” on your Transport Module.

E1 RJ 48 transmitter/receiver
One balanced 120 RJ 48 transmitter/receiver allows you to connect the Dual Module Carrier,
Transport Module, and MSAM to an E1 (2M) circuit to transmit and analyze traffic. The E1 RJ 48
connector may be labeled “2M” on your Transport Module.

DS1 connectors
Two DS1 Bantam receivers and one DS1 Bantam transmitter allow you to connect the module to a
DS1 circuit to transmit and analyze traffic. The Rx 2 receiver can be used as the input for a DS1
BITS signal.

About the CSAM Assembly


The CSAM is used in combination with the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 6000A base unit, the T-BERD ⁄ MTS
6000AV2 base unit or a T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit with a DMC chassis. Each CMSAM is
factory-configured to meet your unique testing requirements.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 19
Chapter 1 Overview
About the CSAM Assembly

Figure 9 T-BERD ⁄ MTS 6000AV2 with CSAM user interface


When you place an order for an CSAM, a customer service or sales representative will help you
determine the following:

– Whether you want to use the CSAM with a T-BERD ⁄ MTS 6000A base unit, or with a
T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit with a Dual Module Carrier (DMCv2).
– If you ordered an SFP or XFP PIM, the transceivers are required. A variety of JDSU-approved
SFP and XFP transceivers are available for each PIM.
For assembly instructions, see “Inserting MSAMs or CSAMs into the 6000A base unit or DMC” on
page 39.

Table 3 on page 13 lists the chassis requirements for each of the circuits and applications supported
by the Transport Module and CSAM. All dual port applications require two connectors on the panel.

Exploring the CSAM connector panel


The CSAM connector panel provides the connectors used to connect the module to the circuit for
testing. See Figure 10.

Clock out/1PPS External Clock CFP2 QSFP+ SFP+


connector Reference 40/100G connectors 40G connectors connectors

Figure 10 CSAM Connector Panel

External Clock Reference and Clock Out/1PPS connectors


These connectors provide input/output of synchronization reference signals (BITS, SETS,
2.048MHz, 100Mhz) and allow you to connect the CSAM to external sources to obtain synchroni-
zation timing signals. The Clock Out/1PPS connector can be used as an input or output.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
20 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
About the CSAM Assembly

CFP2 40/100G connectors


Single CFP connectors (labeled CFP2 40/100G) allow you to connect the CSAM for 40G SONET
or SDH testing, 40 Gigabit or 100 Gigabit Ethernet testing, or to connect to an OTU3 (43.02 G) or
OTU4 (111.8 G) circuit to transmit and then analyze traffic.

MPO Connectivity
The ‘LR4’ interfaces for 40GE & 100GE are based on regular single mode fibers and use LC
connectors. The ‘SRx’ interfaces are based on multimode ribbon cables are use very different MPO
connectors.

The 40GBASE-SR4 (typically on QSFP+) and 100GBASE-SR10 (on CFP or CFP2 or CXP) inter-
faces use MPO connectors. Connectivity between test equipment and network equipment is
achieved using a crossover MPO multi-mode ribbon fiber cable. The term MTP is also used in this
context; it is a registered trademark and identifies a specific brand of the MPO-style connector.

40GBASE-SR4 interfaces use single row MPO connectors with 12 fiber terminations.

Figure 11 12-fiber MPO connector

100GBASE-SR10 interfaces use double row MPO connectors with 24 fiber terminations.

Figure 12 24-fiber MPO connector

QSFP+ 40G connectors


Single 40G connectors (labeled QSFP+ 40G) allow you to connect the CSAM for 40G SONET or
SDH testing, 40 Gigabit Ethernet testing, or to connect to an OTU3 (43.02G) circuit to transmit and
then analyze traffic. Connector specifications are manufacturer dependent.

SFP+ connectors
Two SFP connectors allow you to connect the CSAM to a SONET, SDH, 1 Gigabit Ethernet,
100 FX, 100M, or 1, 2, or 4 Gigabit Fibre Channel circuit to transmit and then analyze traffic. If your
unit is configured and optioned to do so, you can also analyze IP Video traffic on the Ethernet
circuits. OTU-1 connections are only supported on PORT# 1.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 21
Chapter 1 Overview
About the MSAM Assembly

About the MSAM Assembly


The MSAM is used in combination with the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 6000A base unit, the T-BERD ⁄ MTS
6000AV2 base unit or a T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit with a DMC chassis. Each MSAM is factory-
configured to meet your unique testing requirements.

Figure 13 T-BERD ⁄ MTS 6000A with MSAM user interface

Figure 14 T-BERD ⁄ MTS 6000AV2 with MSAM user interface

When you place an order for an MSAM, a customer service or sales representative will help you
determine the following:

– Whether you want to use the MSAM with a


T-BERD ⁄ MTS 6000A base unit, or with a
T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit with a Dual Module Carrier (DMC).
– The type of MSAM chassis required (for example, you can order a single or dual port chassis
that supports PIMs designed for 1.544 Mbps through 10 Gigabit testing).
– The PIM (or PIMs) required for testing 1.544 Mbps through 10 Gigabit circuits. If you ordered a
dual port chassis and you intend to use both ports simultaneously (for example, in dual port
through mode), PIMs should be ordered for both ports.
– If you ordered an SFP or XFP PIM, the transceivers are required. A variety of JDSU-approved
SFP and XFP transceivers are available for each PIM.
The plug in panel of the MSAM provides one or more physical interface module (PIM) ports. Before
connecting the instrument to the circuit for testing, you must insert the required PIMs into the ports,
and then insert the appropriate SFPs or XFPs into the transceiver cages provided on the PIMs.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
22 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
About the MSAM Assembly

MSAM chassis
Each MSAM chassis provides the application module software, one or two PIM ports, and a
75 OHM BNC connector (used for external timing). Several types of chassis are available; there-
fore, your unit may not have both of the ports illustrated in Figure 15.

MSAM
chassis

BNC
connector

XFP PIM with one SFP PIM with two


transceiver cage transceiver cages

Figure 15 MSAM chassis (dual port with XFP and SFP PIMs)

NOTE:
The MSAMv2 chassis has an additional USB host connector to the right of Port 2 and the BNC
EXT REF connector is replaced with a SMA CLK I/O connector.

Table 4 lists the available MSAMchassis.

Table 4 MSAM chassis


Catalog Number Description

C0400 Single Port 1.544 Mbps to 4 Gbps

C0400-v2 Single Port 1.544 Mbps to 10 Gbps


C0404 Dual Porta 1.544 Mbps to 4 Gbps

C0404-v2 Dual Port 1.544 Mbps to 6 Gbps

C1000 Single Port 1.544 Mbps to 10 Gigabit

C1000LB Single Port 10 Mbps to 10 Gbps Loopback Only

C1004 Dual Porta – One 1.544 Mbps to 10 Gbps port


– One 1.544 Mbps to 4 Gbps port

C1010-v2 Dual Port 1.544 Mbps to 10 Gbps

a. A dual port chassis is required if you intend to use the MSAM for OTN testing.

The MSAMv2 USB connector provides analog audio. An analog headset and JDSU USB-to-analog
adapter are required. When using the MSAMv2, the audio from the MSAMv2 is used (USB audio
from the base unit is disabled). USB 2.0 is not supported. For best audio quality, the switch on the
headset should be set to the lowest position (the smallest of the three dots, closest to the wire).

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 23
Chapter 1 Overview
About the MSAM Assembly

The MSAMv2 SMA connector provides access to external reference timing

CAUTION: DAMAGE TO COMPONENTS


Use caution when connecting the cable to the SMA connector. Overtightening could damage
internal components. Finger tighten only.

For assembly instructions, see “Inserting MSAMs or CSAMs into the 6000A base unit or DMC” on
page 39.

MSAM PIMS
Table 4 lists the PIMs available for testing from various interfaces using the MSAM.

Table 5 MSAM PIMs


Compatible
Catalog Number Description
Chassis

CPHSDATA Data communications PIM with universal data communi- C0404


cations connector. C1004
C0404-v2
C1010-v2

CPCDI Diphase PIM with dual BNC connectors C0404


C1004
C0404-v2
C1010-v2

CPDS1BANT DS1 jitter capable PIM with Bantam connector All


A DS1 PIM is shown in Figure 18 on page 26.

CPE1BNC E1 jitter capable PIM with BNC connector All


An E1 PIM with a BNC connector is shown in Figure 19
on page 26.

CPE1RJ48 E1 jitter capable PIM with RJ-48 connector All

CPE3DS3BNC E3/DS3/STS-1 jitter capable PIM All


An E3/DS3/STS-1 PIM is shown in Figure 20 on
page 26.

CPE4STM1BNC E4/STM-1e jitter capable PIM with BNC connector All


An E4/STM1(e) PIM is shown in Figure 21 on page 27.

CPSFP SFP PIM All


Provides two transceiver ports, allowing you to insert
two transceivers designed to support different wave-
lengths. Only one transceiver can be used for testing at
a time.
An SFP PIM is shown in Figure 15 on page 23.

CPSFPPLUS SFP+ PIM All


Provides two transceiver ports, allowing you to insert
two SFP or SFP+ capable transceivers designed to sup-
port different wavelengths.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
24 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
About the MSAM Assembly

Table 5 MSAM PIMs (Continued)


Compatible
Catalog Number Description
Chassis

CPXFP XFP PIM C1000


Provides one transceiver port. C1004
An XFP PIM is shown in Figure 15 on page 23. C1000LB
C1010-v2

CPRJSYNCE SyncE PIM All

Photos of the HS Datacom and Diphase PIMs are provided in Figure 16 and Figure 17.

Figure 16 Datacom PIM

Figure 17 Diphase PIM

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 25
Chapter 1 Overview
About the MSAM Assembly

Photos of the DS1, E1 BNC, E1 RJ-48, E3/DS3/STS-1, and E4/STM-1e PIMs are provided in
Figure 18 on page 26 through Figure 21 on page 27.

Figure 18 DS1 PIM

Figure 19 E1 BNC PIM

Figure 20 E3/DS3/STS-1 PIM

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
26 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
About the DMC Assembly

Figure 21 E4/STM1(e) PIM

For assembly instructions, see “Inserting a PIM into the MSAM” on page 41.

Restrictions
With the introduction of the MSAMv2, 6000Av2, and 8000v2, new applications are enabled due to
variations in the design. If you require voice support for DS VF and VoIP you are encouraged to use
a MSAMv2 with all versions of the 6000A and 8000 mainframes.

About the DMC Assembly


The DMC chassis is used with the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit. It provides two MSAM or CSAM
slots, allowing you to insert two MSAMs and up to four PIMs. This provides connections for testing
four independent circuits simultaneously.

MSAM or
CSAM slot

MSAM or
CSAM slot

Figure 22 T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit with a DMC

Figure 22 shows a DMC connected to a base unit. For assembly instructions, see “Connecting a
Transport Module or DMC to a base unit” on page 32.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 27
Chapter 1 Overview
Inserting an SFP or XFP transceiver

Base unit requirements


if you intend to test using two MSAMs in a DMC chassis, verify that the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base
unit satisfies the requirements stated in Table 6 on page 33.

If your base unit does not satisfy the DMC requirements, contact JDSU Customer Care for instruc-
tions on returning the base unit for a factory upgrade. For details, see “Returning equipment to
JDSU” on page 209.

Restrictions
With the introduction of the MSAMv2, 6000Av2, and 8000v2, new applications are enabled due to
variations in the design. If you require voice support for DS VF and VoIP you are encouraged to use
a MSAMv2 with all versions of the 6000A and 8000 mainframes.

Inserting an SFP or XFP transceiver


The SFP ports allow you to insert SFP transceivers designed for testing a variety of optical circuits.
Additionally, the T-BERD/MTS 5812 and 5812P configurations also offer an XFP port, which allows
you to insert a XFP transceiver to establish connections to 10Gig circuits.

Before inserting an SFP or XFP, consider the following:

– Applied power must not exceed the power level specified on the panel for each optical
connector.
– Use the SFPs that shipped with your unit, or SFPs on the list of JDSU supported optics (trans-
ceivers) that shipped with your instrument. The recommended optics are also available on
your unit by selecting Help > Recommended Optics. These SFPs can be purchased from
JDSU.
– Verify that the transceiver and the connector support the same physical interfaces. For
example, if you intend to connect to a 10 Gigabit Ethernet circuit, verify that you are inserting
an XFP into an XFP port.
– Details concerning the SFP or XFP used for the currently selected application are available on
the Interface setup tab.

To insert an SFP or XFP transceiver


1 Obtain an SFP or XFP transceiver from JDSU that supports the physical interface you intend to
test.
If you are not certain which interfaces a particular transceiver supports, refer to the list of
JDSU Recommended Optics.
If you can not locate the sheet, in most instances an online search using the model number
(printed on the SFP or XFP label) will result in a number of hits providing specifications for the
transceiver.
2 After verifying that you have the correct SFP or XFP for the interface, do the following:
a Position the instrument with the connector panel facing towards you.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
28 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 1 Overview
Removing an SFP or XFP transceiver

b Ensure that the bale-clasp latch on the SFP is closed as illustrated in Figure 23. The bale-
clasp latch handle should be on top of the SFP module.

Figure 23 SFP transceiver with closed bail-clasp latch

c With the SFP label facing away from you, align the SFP with the connector cage, and then
gently but firmly insert the SFP until it is seated securely, indicated by an audible click, or
by feeling the SFP snap into place.
NOTE:
The user interface may show the SFP as available before it is seated securely. Be sure to insert
the SFP until you hear the click or feel it snap into place.

CAUTION: DAMAGE TO UNIT:


If you feel any resistance when first inserting the SFP into the cage, do not force it any further.
The bottom of the SFP may be obstructed by the latch tab in the cage, and forcing it any
further may damage the cage.
If this occurs, do the following:
Remove the SFP, then push the latch tab in the cage down.
Verify that the bale-clasp latch on the SFP is completely closed, re-align the SFP with the
cage, and then insert it again.

NOTE:
Although it is possible to insert an RJ-45 SFP into a SFP port on the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000,
6000A, and 5800, the instrument will issue an error message if this is done. Insert optical SFPs
into the SFP ports. Use the fixed RJ-45 test ports for 10/100/1000 testing.

The transceiver is inserted. Be certain to replace the rubber cover on the SFP or XFP when it is not
in use.

NOTE: Laser warm up requirement


When testing 10 Gigabit optical circuits using an XFP, some lasers (particularly 1550 nm lasers)
are temperature stabilized; therefore, the XFP need to reach a certain temperature before you
can use them to transmit a signal. This is expected behavior, and does not indicate that there is
something wrong with the laser or test instrument.
It typically takes up to one minute for the temperature to stabilize. If you have turned the laser
on, but no signal is present on the receiving instrument or device, simply wait for one minute.

Removing an SFP or XFP transceiver


To prolong the life of your transceivers, leave the SFPs or XFPs you intend to use most frequently
in the instrument until you need to replace them with transceivers designed for a different circuit.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 29
Chapter 1 Overview
JDSU recommended SFPs and XFPs

To remove an SFP or XFP transceiver


1 If necessary, remove the dust cover, or any cables that are currently connected to the trans-
ceiver. If you need to remove a cable, do the following:
a Press the release latch on the cable.
b Grasp the cable connector near the connection point.
c Gently pull the cable connector from the transceiver.
d Insert a dust plug into the open end of the transceiver.
2 Open the bail-clasp latch (as illustrated in Figure 24), and grasp the latch and pull gently
upwards to remove the transceiver from the cage.

Figure 24 SFP transceiver with open bail-clasp latch

The transceiver is removed. Be certain to store it in an anti-static bag.

JDSU recommended SFPs and XFPs


To ensure proper operation of your instrument during testing, we strongly recommend purchasing
the required transceivers from JDSU. These transceivers have been tested to verify that they will
perform reliably with our test instruments.

A list of recommended transceivers can be found by selecting Recommended Optics from the
Help menu. Or you can obtain the list by contacting JDSU Customer Care, or contacting JDSU via
the company web site, www.jdsu.com.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
30 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
2
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument

This chapter explains how to assemble the components of your T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800, MSAM or
Transport Module before testing. Topics discussed in this chapter include the following:

– “Unpacking the components” on page 32


– “Inspecting the components for damage” on page 32
– “Connecting a Transport Module or DMC to a base unit” on page 32
– “Inserting MSAMs or CSAMs into the 6000A base unit or DMC” on page 39
– “Inserting a PIM into the MSAM” on page 41
– “Removing a PIM” on page 42
– “Swapping PIMs” on page 43
– “Inserting a SFP/SFP+, XFP or QSFP+ transceiver” on page 43
– “Inserting a CFP or CFP2 transceiver” on page 45
– “Removing an SFP/SFP+, XFP or QSFP+ transceiver” on page 46
– “Removing a CFP or CFP2 transceiver” on page 46
– “Attaching an external optical connector” on page 47
– “Disconnecting the Transport Module or DMC” on page 48

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 31
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Unpacking the components

Unpacking the components


JDSU typically ships the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800, Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM
using anti-static packing material to stabilize the components inside the box. If you ordered a base
unit and application module (and, if applicable, a DMC), the components are assembled when they
are shipped to you.

When unpacking the components, verify that all the items you ordered are included in the package.
Accessories may be shipped in a separate box.

After you unpack the components, you should inspect them for damage.

If undamaged, consider saving the box and packing materials in case you need to repackage the
components for shipment. For information about shipping equipment, see Appendix B “Storage
and Shipment” .

Inspecting the components for damage


After you unpack the components, examine the connectors, ports, LEDs, and screen for damage.
Be sure to check the top, bottom, and front panels of each component.

If you find damage, contact JDSU Customer Care at


1-855-ASK-JDSU or at www.jdsu.com. For information about returning equipment, see “Returning
equipment to JDSU” on page 209.

Connecting a Transport Module or DMC to a base unit


Before connecting your new Transport Module or DMC to a T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit, review
the key principles and base unit requirements, and gather the proper tools.

Key principles
When connecting or disconnecting the instrument components, focus on the following principles to
ensure a secure connection and avoid damaging the connectors:

Sequence. If you are connecting a DMC to an 8000 base unit, the DMC must be connected directly
to the base unit with no modules between the base unit and the DMC. If you are connecting two
DMCs, they must be the first two modules attached, and the first DMC must be connected directly
to the base unit. You can attach additional modules after connecting the DMC (or DMCs) to the base
unit.

Alignment. Ensure that the holes on the corners of the Transport Module, DMC, or Battery Module
are aligned with the holes on the component you are attaching it to. For example, if you are
attaching the DMC to the base unit, ensure that the holes of the DMC are aligned with the holes on
the base unit.

Parallel position. Ensure that you are holding the Transport Module, DMC, or Battery Module in a
position parallel to the base unit or DMC (as illustrated in Figure 29 on page 37). If either module is
held at even a slight angle, there is a risk of damage to the connectors.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
32 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Connecting a Transport Module or DMC to a base unit

Proper torque. Ensure that you tighten the screw using the hex key (for the Transport Module or
DMC) or a flat blade screwdriver (for the Battery Module) until you feel a slight resistance, and then
tighten it using an additional 1/4 turn. If you are using a torque wrench, apply 1.5 N-m (13.3 in-lb)
to the final turn.

Verifying the base unit requirements


Before connecting a Transport Module or DMC to a base unit, verify that the base unit satisfies the
requirement stated in Table 6.

Table 6 T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit requirements


High-Speed
Transport Module
Requirement Transport Module DMC
(10G or below)
(40G/ 100G)

Serial number of 336 or above X N/A X

Touch screen X X X

Hard drive X X X

BERT Software Version 5 or above X


(Version 2 Transport
Module Chassis)

BERT Software Version 7.0 or above X


(Version 3 Transport
Module Chassis)

BERT Software Version 8.0 or above Xa


BERT Software Version 14.0 or above X

400MHz CPU X X

1000MHz CPU X

256 MB DRAM X X

2GB DRAM X

a. Software version 8.0 can also be run on the Transport Module and MSAM assemblies.

To verify the requirements on a base unit


1 Press the SYSTEM/HOME key.

NOTE:
Depending on the version of T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit you have, the key may be labeled
SYSTEM or may be labeled HOME (on UIMv2).

2 To verify the current BERT software version, select the Help Page soft key.
Under Software Version Information, observe the BERT software version.
– If the software version is lower than Version 5.0, you must upgrade the software on your
base unit before connecting a Version 2 Transport Module.
– If the software version is lower than Version 7.0, you must upgrade the software on your
base unit before connecting a Version 3 Transport Module.
– If the software version is lower than Version 8.0, you must upgrade the software on your
base unit before connecting a DMC.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 33
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Connecting a Transport Module or DMC to a base unit

3 To verify the CPU speed and DRAM, select the Services Data soft key.
Under Services Data, check the CPU speed and the Memory.
If your base unit does not meet the requirements stated above, contact JDSU Customer Care for
assistance.

NOTE:
Base unit software upgrades are available on JDSU Network and Service Enablement Customer
Care site at www.jdsu.com.

Required tools
– Large, flat blade screwdriver. You will need a large, flat blade screwdriver to remove and then
replace the battery module on the base unit.
– Hex key. A hex key is provided in a groove on the inside panel of the battery module. This key
is used to secure and then tighten the screws that connect the Transport Module or DMC to the
base unit.

Connecting the components

To connect the Transport Module or DMC to a base unit


1 Verify that power is OFF on your base unit and that the power adapter is unplugged.
2 Using the large flat blade screwdriver, loosen each of the 4 slotted bolts on the back panel of
the battery module (attached to the base unit).
3 Disconnect the battery module from the base unit, and then remove the hex key from the
groove on the inside panel of the battery module. See Figure 25.

Hex Key groove

Figure 25 Hex key groove in battery module

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
34 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Connecting a Transport Module or DMC to a base unit

4 The base unit, Transport Module, and DMC each have rectangular mating connectors (see
Figure 26 and Figure 27).

Base Unit Mating Connector

Figure 26 Base Unit Mating Connector

These connectors must be aligned carefully before connecting the module to the base unit.
CAUTION:
The 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module will only function properly when attached to an
MTS 8000E Base Unit.

To align the connectors properly:


a Place the base unit with the screen side down on your work surface. The mating
connector on the back panel should be facing you, at the top side of the unit (see
Figure 27).

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 35
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Connecting a Transport Module or DMC to a base unit

Transport Module Mating Connector

Figure 27 Transport Module Mating Connector

DMC Mating Connector

Figure 28 DMC Mating Connector


b Position the Transport Module or DMC over the base unit, with the Transport Module or
DMC’s mating connector directly over the mating connector on the base unit.
c Verify that the holes on each corner of the Transport Module or DMC are aligned
precisely with the holes on each corner of the base unit.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
36 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Connecting a Transport Module or DMC to a base unit

d IMPORTANT: Verify that you are holding the Transport Module or DMC in a position
parallel to the base unit (see Figure 29). If the module or DMC is tilted at even a slight
angle, the mating connectors may not connect properly.

Transport Module

align align

parallel position

Base Unit

Figure 29 Proper alignment of Transport Module and Base Unit

5 Slowly lower the Transport Module or DMC until it is just over the holes on the base unit, and
then gently but firmly press the center of the module to attach it to the base unit.
6 Starting at the upper right corner, do the following:
a Using the hex key that you removed from the battery module, tighten screws 1 through 4
(in the sequence illustrated in Figure 30) until you feel a slight resistance. The same
sequence is used when attaching a Transport Module or DMC.
b After all four screws are tightened, using the hex key, tighten each screw at least one
additional quarter-turn in the sequence illustrated in Figure 30.
1

Figure 30 Sequence for securing and tightening the screws (Transport Module
illustrated)

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 37
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Connecting a Transport Module or DMC to a base unit

7 After the Transport Module or DMC is secured to the base unit, put the hex key back in the
battery module, and then do the following:
a Position the battery module over the Transport Module or DMC, with the battery
module’s mating connector directly over the mating connector on the Transport Module
or DMC.
b Verify that the holes on each corner of the battery module are aligned precisely with the
holes on each corner of the Transport Module or DMC.
c IMPORTANT: Verify that you are holding the battery module in a position parallel to the
Transport Module or DMC. If the module is tilted at even a slight angle, the mating
connectors may not connect properly.
8 Slowly lower the battery module until it is just over the holes on the Transport Module or
DMC, and then gently but firmly press the center of the battery module to attach it to the
Transport Module or DMC.
9 Starting at the upper right corner, do the following:
a Using the large flat blade screwdriver, tighten screws 1 through 4 until you feel a slight
resistance. Use the same sequence illustrated for the Transport Module or DMC screws
in Figure 30.
b After all four screws are tightened, tighten each screw at least one additional quarter-
turn.
The Transport Module or DMC is connected to the base unit. It is completely assembled, and can
be used for testing.

Before testing using the DMC, you must insert the MSAM(s) and the appropriate PIMs for the
circuits you intend to test. For details, see “Inserting MSAMs or CSAMs into the 6000A base unit or
DMC” on page 39 and “Inserting a PIM into the MSAM” on page 41.

Connecting multiple Transport Modules to a base unit


In some instances, if you connect multiple modules to the base unit, the BNC connectors on one
module make it difficult to open the dust caps on the optical connectors of an adjacent module.
Following the guidelines below should resolve the issue:

– If you have a module configured with two port receptacles, connect that module to the base unit
first.
– If you have a Transport Module configured without BNC connectors and a Transport Module
with BNC connectors, connect the module with BNC connectors to the base unit first, and then
connect the module without BNC connectors.

Connecting two DMCs to a base unit


If you intend to connect two DMCs to a base unit for testing, verify that you are using an AC power
adapter that can support your assembly. To discuss the various power adapters available for your
instrument, contact JDSU Customer Care, or contact JDSU via the company web site,
www.jdsu.com.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
38 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Inserting MSAMs or CSAMs into the 6000A base unit or DMC

Inserting MSAMs or CSAMs into the 6000A base unit or DMC


Before inserting an MSAM or CSAM into the 6000A base unit or DMC, review the MSAM/CSAM
requirements, and gather the proper tools.

IMPORTANT:
Be certain the base unit is powered OFF and power adapter is unplugged before inserting or
swapping MSAMs or CSAMs.

MSAM requirements
Before inserting an MSAM into a DMC, verify that the MSAM is labeled as DMC-compatible. If it is
not, you must return it to JDSU for a factory upgrade before using it with a DMC.

The DMC-compatible MSAMs can be inserted into any T-BERD ⁄ MTS 6000A base unit or DMC.

CSAM requirements
A 150W power supply is required when used in a 6000Av2 (MSAM can use a 90W or 150W PS)

The “module carrier” for the 6000Av2 for CSAM must be an E6300.

The software checks for compatibility and blocks you if the module is not compatible with the
module carrier.

Required tools
You will need a large, flat blade screwdriver to secure the MSAM or CSAM in the T-BERD ⁄ MTS
6000A base unit or the DMC chassis.

Inserting the MSAM or CSAM

To insert the MSAMor CSAM into the DMC chassis


1 Verify the following:
– Power is OFF on your base unit.
– The power adapter is unplugged.
2 Place the base unit on a flat surface, with the screen facing down, and the application module
slots on the base unit or DMC chassis facing towards you.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 39
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Inserting MSAMs or CSAMs into the 6000A base unit or DMC

3 Hold the MSAMor CSAM with the exterior panel facing towards you. The thumb screws
should be at the top of the panel, for the MSAM, the BNC connector should be on the bottom
right side of the panel.

Screw
Screw PIM Ejection
Ejection
Ports Button
Button BNC

Figure 31 MSAM inserted into the DMC chassis

4 Align the MSAM or CSAM with the application module slot, and then gently but firmly slide it
into the slot. Figure 31 shows an MSAM in a DMC application module slot; a similar slot is
also available on the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 6000A base unit.
5 Place your thumbs just below each of the thumbscrews on the top of the MSAM/CSAM panel,
then push the MSAM/CSAM into the slot until the exterior panel of the MSAM/CSAM is flush
with the side panel of the base unit or DMC chassis (see Figure 32 and Figure 33).

Figure 32 Fully inserted MSAM

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
40 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Inserting a PIM into the MSAM

Figure 33 DMC with CSAM inserted (left) and MSAM v2 inserted (right)

6 Using the screwdriver, tighten each screw. You can also use your fingers to tighten the
screws; however, using the screwdriver will ensure a more secure connection.
The MSAMor CSAM is connected to the base unit or DMC chassis.

Inserting a PIM into the MSAM


After connecting the MSAM to the base unit or DMC chassis, you can insert a PIM into one of the
ports provided on the MSAM to provide the physical interfaces you need to connect to the circuit for
testing.

To insert a PIM into the MSAM


1 Verify that the MSAM is designed to support the PIM that you intend to insert by doing the
following:
– If you are inserting an SFP PIM, it will work with any available MSAM chassis, in any port.
Simply look at the PIM label to verify that it is an SFP PIM.
– If you are inserting an XFP PIM, it requires a high rate MSAM chassis. These chassis are
labeled with a C1000, C1004, C0400-v2, C0404-v2, or C1010-v2 model number on the
exterior panel. After verifying that the chassis can support the PIM, look at the PIM label to
verify that it is an XFP PIM.
2 Place the base unit on a flat surface, with the screen facing down, and the exterior panel of
the MSAM facing towards you.
3 If you are inserting the PIM into a dual port chassis, determine which port to insert the PIM
into.
– All ports support 10 Mbps to 4 Gbps interfaces; therefore, if you are inserting an SFP PIM
you can use any port.
– If you are inserting an XFP PIM, you must use the left port (labeled Port #1), unless you
have a dual 10G MSAMv2 (labeled C1010-v2) which allows an XFP on either port.
4 After verifying that the port supports the same physical interface(s) as the PIM, align the PIM
with the transceiver cages facing you, and the internal connectors facing down towards the
interior of the port.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 41
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Removing a PIM

5 Insert the PIM into the port (see Figure 34).

Figure 34 XFP PIM in Port #1

6 Push the PIM into the port until the PIM panel is flush with the exterior panel of the chassis,
and the PIM ejection button pops out.
The PIM is inserted.

Removing a PIM
There are two types of PIMs: single port and dual port. The single port PIMs fit into a single port (for
example, the DS1 PIM); dual port PIMs are wider and use both ports (for example, the datacom
PIM). Thus, there are slightly different ways to remove the PIMs.

To remove a single port PIM


1 On the exterior panel of the MSAM chassis, press the PIM ejection button.
The PIM is released.
2 Pull the PIM out of the port.

To remove a dual port PIM


1 Rotate the long front lever. This will press both of the PIM ejection buttons.
The PIM is released.
2 Pull the PIM out of the ports.
The PIM is removed from the MSAM chassis.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
42 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Swapping PIMs

Swapping PIMs
If you need to swap PIMs during testing, you must turn the BERT (MSAM) module off, remove one
PIM, and then insert another. If you are swapping PIMs in two MSAMs in the DMC, be certain to
turn the BERT (MSAM) module off for both MSAMs. You do not need to turn OFF the instrument.

NOTE:
If you do not turn the BERT (MSAM) module off, you will lose the settings for the last test you
configured, and your MSAM may not launch the expected test application automatically when
you insert a different PIM.

To swap PIMs
1 Press the SYSTEM/HOME button to display the System screen, then turn the icon repre-
senting the BERT (MSAM) module off. The BERT (MSAM) module can be toggled on or off by
selecting the BERT icon. When off, the icon is grey.
2 Press the Results soft key to go to the MSAM status screen, and then verify that the module
is off by observing the Message bar at the top of the screen. When off, the message states:
BERT Module OFF
3 After verifying that the BERT (MSAM) module is off, remove the PIM (see “Removing a PIM”
on page 42).
4 Insert the new PIM (see “Inserting a PIM into the MSAM” on page 41).
5 On the System screen, turn the BERT module back on. When on, the icon is yellow.
The PIMs are swapped.

Inserting a SFP/SFP+, XFP or QSFP+ transceiver


If you have a 5800, CSAM, Version 3 Transport Module chassis with SFP/SFP+ connectors, or an
MSAM, you can insert SFP/SFP+ transceivers designed for testing a variety of optical circuits. The
5800v1 uses SFP while the 5800v2 uses SFP+. The MSAM also offers an XFP PIM, which allows
you to insert XFP transceivers to establish connections to 10Gig circuits. The CSAM and High
Speed 40/100G Transport Module accept QSFP+ and CFP2 transceivers. All of these modules
have similar insertion characteristics.

Before inserting an SFP/SFP+, XFP, or QSFP+, consider the following:

– Applied power must not exceed the power level specified on the panel for each optical
connector.
– Use the transceivers that shipped with your unit, or on the list of JDSU supported optics (trans-
ceivers) that shipped with your instrument. The recommended optics are also available on your
unit by selecting Help > Recommended Optics. Many of these transceivers can be purchased
from JDSU.
– Verify that the transceiver and the PIM or connector on the Transport Module support the same
physical interfaces. For example, if you intend to connect an MSAM to a 10 Gigabit Ethernet
circuit, verify that you are inserting an XFP into an XFP PIM.
– When you configure your test, if you are using an SFP/SFP+ (as opposed to an XFP or
QSFP+), you must indicate which connector you are using for the test (SFP 1, or SFP 2). If you
are configuring a test on the MSAM, and you select a 10Gig application, this is not necessary
because there is only one port available on the XFP PIM.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 43
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Inserting a SFP/SFP+, XFP or QSFP+ transceiver

– Details concerning the SFP/SFP+, XFP or QSFP+ used for the currently selected application
are available on the Interface setup tab.

To insert a SFP/SFP+, XFP or QSFP+ transceiver


1 Obtain a transceiver from JDSU that supports the physical interface you intend to test.
If you are not certain which interfaces a particular transceiver supports, refer to the list of
JDSU Recommended Optics.
If you can not locate the sheet, in most instances an online search using the model number
(printed on the transceiver label) will result in a number of hits providing specifications for the
transceiver.
2 After verifying that you have the correct transceiver for the interface, do the following:
a Position the instrument with the connector panel facing towards you.
b If you are inserting a transceiver into the Transport Module, remove the dust cover from
the SFP/SFP+ connector.
c Ensure that the bale-clasp latch on the transceiver is closed as illustrated in Figure 35.
The bale-clasp latch handle should be on top of the transceiver module.

Figure 35 Transceiver (SFP shown) with closed bail-clasp latch

d With the identification label facing away from you, align the transceiver with the
connector cage, and then gently but firmly insert the transceiver until it is seated
securely (indicated by an audible click, or by feeling the transceiver snap into place).
CAUTION: DAMAGE TO UNIT
If you feel any resistance when first inserting the transceiver into the cage, do not force it any
further. The bottom of the transceiver may be obstructed by the latch tab in the cage, and forcing
it any further may damage the cage.
If this occurs, do the following:
– Remove the transceiver, then push the latch tab in the cage down.
– Verify that you are inserting it correctly (for example, face-up vs face-down)
– Verify that the bale-clasp latch on the transceiver is completely closed, realign it with the
cage, and then insert it again.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
44 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Inserting a CFP or CFP2 transceiver

The transceiver is inserted; be certain to cover the optical connector openings when they are not in
use.

NOTE: Laser warm up requirement


When testing 10 Gigabit, 40 Gigabit or 100 Gigabit optical circuits, some lasers (particularly
1550 nm lasers) are temperature stabilized; and therefore need to reach a certain temperature
before you can use them to transmit a signal. This is expected behavior, and does not indicate
that there is something wrong with the laser or test instrument.
It typically takes up to one minute for the temperature to stabilize. If you have turned the laser on,
but no signal is present on the receiving instrument or device, simply wait for one minute.

Inserting a CFP or CFP2 transceiver


The CSAM and High Speed 40/100G Transport Module accept CFP and CFP2 transceivers.

Before inserting a CFP or CFP2 transceiver consider the following:

– Applied power must not exceed the power level specified on the panel for each optical
connector.
– The recommended optics are available on your unit by selecting Help > Recommended
Optics.
– Details concerning the CFP or CFP2 used for the currently selected application are available
on the Interface setup tab.

Inserting a CFP or CFP2 transceiver


1 Obtain a transceiver that supports the physical interface you intend to test.
If you are not certain which interfaces a particular transceiver supports, refer to the list of
JDSU Recommended Optics.
If you can not locate the sheet, in most instances an online search using the model number
(printed on the transceiver label) will result in a number of hits providing specifications for the
transceiver.
2 After verifying that you have the correct transceiver for the interface, do the following:
a Position the instrument with the display facing towards you and the connector panel on
the top.
b With the identification label facing you, align the transceiver in the slot, and then gently
but firmly insert the transceiver until it is seated securely (indicated by an audible click, or
by feeling the transceiver snap into place).
CAUTION: DAMAGE TO UNIT
If you feel any resistance when first inserting the transceiver into the unit or when tightening the
retaining screws, do not force it any further. The bottom of the transceiver may be obstructed.
If this occurs, do the following:
– Remove the transceiver.
– Visually inspect for any mechanical impediments to proper insertion and repair or replace the
defective part.
– Verify that you are inserting it correctly (for example, face-up vs face-down)
– Reinsert the CFP.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 45
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Removing an SFP/SFP+, XFP or QSFP+ transceiver

c Tighten the retaining screws (if equipped) until they are finger tight.
The transceiver is inserted; be certain to cover the optical connector openings when they are
not in use.
NOTE: Laser warm up requirement
When testing 10 Gigabit, 40 Gigabit and 100 Gigabit optical circuits, some lasers (particularly
1550 nm lasers) are temperature stabilized; and therefore need to reach a certain temperature
before you can use them to transmit a signal. This is expected behavior, and does not indicate
that there is something wrong with the laser or test instrument.
It typically takes up to one minute for the temperature to stabilize. If you have turned the laser on,
but no signal is present on the receiving instrument or device, simply wait for one minute.

Removing an SFP/SFP+, XFP or QSFP+ transceiver


To prolong the life of your transceivers, leave the transceiver you intend to use most frequently in
the instrument until you need to replace them with transceivers designed for a different circuit.

To remove a transceiver
1 If necessary, remove the dust cover, or any cables that are currently connected to the trans-
ceiver. If you need to remove a cable, do the following:
a Press the release latch on the cable.
b Grasp the cable connector near the connection point.
c Gently pull the cable connector from the transceiver.
d Insert a dust plug into the open end of the transceiver.
2 Open the bail-clasp latch (as illustrated in Figure 36), and grasp the latch and pull gently
upwards to remove the transceiver from the cage.

Figure 36 Transceiver (SFP shown) with open bail-clasp latch

The transceiver is removed. Be certain to store it in an anti-static bag.

Removing a CFP or CFP2 transceiver


To prolong the life of your transceivers, leave the transceiver you intend to use most frequently in
the instrument until you need to replace them with transceivers designed for a different circuit.

To remove a CFP transceiver


1 If necessary, remove any optical cables that are currently connected to the transceiver. If you
need to remove a cable, do the following:

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
46 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Attaching an external optical connector

a Press the release latch on the cable.


b Grasp the cable connector near the connection point.
c Gently pull the cable connector from the transceiver.
d Insert a dust plug into the open end of the transceiver.
2 Remove any external timing reference cables. If you need to remove an external timing refer-
ence cable do the following:
a Grasp the plug close to the panel.
b Loosen by turning the connector counter-clockwise.
c When connector threads are fully disengaged, pull the plug straight off the jack.
3 Loosen the retaining screws securing the CFP into the Transport Module or flip out bail
handle.
4 Hold onto retaining screws or bail handle and remove the transceiver from the Transport
Module using a steady, gentle pressure.
The transceiver is removed. Be certain to store it in an anti-static bag.

Attaching an external optical connector


The Transport Module also uses external optical connectors. Before attaching an external
connector to your instrument, be certain the connector is clean. If the external connector is new, or
has been used with clean, defect free fiber connectors and capped when not in use, it does not typi-
cally require cleaning.

If you suspect poor performance is due to a dirty cable, connector, or optical jack, refer to “Storing
the instrument” on page 208 of Appendix B “Storage and Shipment” .

To attach an external optical connector


1 Verify that the laser is turned OFF on the Transport Module.
2 Verify that the locking lever of the connector is in a released position.
3 Pinch the connector with your index finger on the top of the locking lever, and your thumb on
the bottom of the connector.
4 Align the connector squarely with the four sides of the optical connector on the panel.
NOTE:
If you insert the connector at an angle you risk damaging the connector.

5 Insert the connector into the optical connector on the panel, and then lock the shell in place
by rotating the locking lever upwards until you hear a click.
The connector is attached. Be certain to cover it with a dust cap if you don’t intend to begin testing
immediately.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 47
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Disconnecting the Transport Module or DMC

Disconnecting the Transport Module or DMC


Before disconnecting the Transport Module or DMC from the base unit, review the “Key principles”
on page 32 for assembling the instrument. The same principals apply when disassembling the
various components.

Required tools

Large, flat blade screwdriver


You will need a large, flat blade screwdriver to remove the battery module.

Hex key (provided)


A 5 mm hex key is provided in a groove on the inside panel of the battery module. This key is used
to secure and then tighten the screws that connect the module to the base unit.

Torque wrench (optional)


If you want to ensure that you don’t apply too much pressure when connecting or disconnecting
components, you can optionally use a torque wrench capable of applying 13.3 in-lb. A torque
wrench with the ability to apply up to 20 in-lb in 0.1 in-lb increments will be adequate. You will also
need a 5 mm hex key bit for the wrench.

Disassembling the instrument

To remove the Transport Module or DMC from a base unit


1 Verify that power is OFF on your base unit and that the power adapter is unplugged.
2 Using the large flat blade screwdriver, loosen each of the 4 slotted bolts on the back panel of
the battery module (attached to the base unit), and then gently remove the battery module.
3 Use the provided hex key to loosen screws 1 through 4 in the sequence illustrated in
Figure 30 on page 37.
4 Turn the base unit over so the display is facing upwards.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
48 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Disconnecting the Transport Module or DMC

5 Disconnect the Transport Module or DMC from the base unit by gently pressing upwards on
the two lower bumpers of the base unit as illustrated in Figure 37 on page 49.

Press Up Bumpers

Figure 37 Bumpers (Base Unit)

IMPORTANT: When lifting the base unit, be certain to apply force directly over the base unit
mating connector (illustrated in Figure 26 on page 35). The lower bumpers are located on the
front (display) panel of the base unit, and they are parallel with the mating connector provided
on the bottom (connector) panel. In Figure 37, the base unit mating connector is not visible; it
is directly above the mating connector of the Transport Module or DMC.
6 After the base unit is completely disengaged from the Transport Module or DMC, lift it up
further and place it elsewhere on your work surface.
The instrument is disassembled.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 49
Chapter 2 Assembling Your Instrument
Disconnecting the Transport Module or DMC

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
50 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
3
Chapter 3 Getting Started

This chapter explains how to start using your 5800, MSAM, or Transport Module, and describes the
user interface for both instruments. Topics discussed in this chapter include the following:

– “Powering the instrument” on page 52


– “Launching the Transport Module or MSAM” on page 55
– “Navigating the user interface” on page 58
– “Setting up the instrument” on page 63
– “Preparing for optical testing” on page 71
– “Connecting the Transport Module to the circuit” on page 75
– “Connecting the MSAM to the circuit” on page 78
– “Connecting the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 to the circuit” on page 79

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 51
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Powering the instrument

Powering the instrument


Power is supplied to the instrument by the battery or the AC power adapter supplied with the appli-
cation module (MSAM, CSAM, or 40/100G Transport Module) or DMC. For the 5800, the adapter
is supplied with the unit. Use of AC adapters or batteries other than those supplied with your unit or
slice/module is not recommended as other slices/modules may be supplied with incompatible
adapters or batteries.

When supplying power using an adapter, consider the following:

– Optical jitter and wander testing — If you intend to use a Transport Module for optical jitter and
wander testing, before you start, you must connect the AC power adapter that shipped with the
Transport Module.
– Multiple (“Stacked”) Transport Module or DMCs — If you intend to test by connecting multiple
Transport Module or DMCs to a single T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit, you will need an adapter
that provides more than the standard 150 Watts.
– Two MSAMs — If you intend to test by using two MSAMs in one DMC module in a single
T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit, you must connect the AC power adapter that shipped with the
DMC.
To discuss the various power adapters available for your instrument, contact JDSU Customer
Care, or contact JDSU via the company web site, www.jdsu.com.

Verifying that you have the correct adapter


Figure 38 shows the label on the adapter that ships with the T-BERD / MTS 5800.

Figure 38 Adapter label

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
52 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Powering the instrument

Figure 39, Figure 40 and Figure 41 show the labels provided on the adapters that ship with the
Transport Module, DMC, MSAM, and 40/100G Transport Module.

Figure 39 Transport Module and DMC adapter label

Figure 40 MSAM Adapter label

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 53
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Powering the instrument

Figure 41 40/100G Power Adapter label

Using the adapter

To supply power using the adapter


1 Verify that the adapter is the one that shipped with your instrument (see “Verifying that you
have the correct adapter” on page 52).
2 Plug the adapter into the power supply jack.
– The jack for the Transport Module or DMC is located on the bottom right-hand corner of the
T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit.
– The jack for the MSAM is located on the top panel of the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 6000A base unit.
– The jack for the T-BERD / MTS 5800 is located on the top panel.
3 Plug the opposite end of the adapter into the power mains.
Power is supplied using the adapter.

For specifications, see “Power supply specifications” on page 142.

Turning on the instrument

To power the instrument


– Press the ON/OFF key.
The On LED, located on the front panel, illuminates green when the unit is powered, and the instru-
ment beeps.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
54 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Launching the Transport Module or MSAM

Turning off the instrument

To turn off the instrument


– Press the ON/OFF key.
The On LED, located on the front panel, extinguishes when the unit turned off, and the instrument
beeps.

Charging the battery


In most instances, the battery charges automatically when you supply power to the unit using the
AC power adapter.

6000A Charge LED


The Charge LED on the front of the 6000A base unit behaves as follows when testing using an
MSAM:

Table 7 Charge LED behavior


Scenario LED State Indicates

Power supplied by adaptera ON The battery is charging.

OFF The battery is not charging.

Power supplied by battery only ON The battery has six minutes or less of power avail-
able. If the Charge LED illuminates when operating
on battery power, supply power using the adapter
immediately.

OFF The battery has more than six minutes of power


available.

a. When running OTU2 applications, or multiple tests with one application that requires an XFP PIM, the unit does not
charge the battery - even when the adapter supplies power. When you launch these applications, the Charge LED
extinguishes to alert you that the battery is not charging. Applications that use the XFP PIM include 10 Gigabit LAN,
10 Gigabit WAN, 10 Gigabit Fibre Channel, OC-192 SONET, STM-64 SDH, and OTU2 OTN.

Launching the Transport Module or MSAM


If the Transport Module or MSAM was launched during your last test session (when you turned the
power OFF), the instrument launches it automatically when you turn power back ON. If the module
was off when you turned power OFF, you must actively launch it after you turn power back ON.

Multiple BERT icons


The Transport Module and MSAM are both represented by a “BERT” icon on the System screen. If
you are using a DMC with two MSAMs, two BERT icons appear on the screen (one for each MSAM.
If you stack multiple Transport Modules or DMCs on a single T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit, an icon
appears for each Transport Module or MSAM.

When multiple BERT icons are available, a yellow icon indicates that the module is active; a green
outline surrounding a yellow icon indicates that the instrument is currently providing the user inter-
face for that particular module (in other words, it is the module in focus).

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 55
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Launching the Transport Module or MSAM

About the Jitter icon


If your Transport Module is configured and optioned for optical jitter/wander testing, before
launching the module, consider the following:

– Connect the power adapter to the power mains before launching the optical jitter/wander func-
tion (see “Powering the instrument” on page 52).
– Turning on the JITTER icon also automatically turns on the BERT function.
– To conserve power, if you are no longer testing optical jitter or wander, turn off the JITTER icon.
All other Transport Module (BERT) applications will still be available.

Turning the BERT icon ON

To turn a BERT icon ON


1 Press the ON/OFF button.
The unit loads the 8000 Base Unit or 6000A Base Unit software, and then the following
occurs:
– The screen goes blank for a few seconds.
– The Presentation page for the base unit appears.
– If the Transport Module or MSAM was launched during your last test session (when you
turned the power OFF), the JDSU BERT MODULES STARTUP screen appears, indicating
the progress of the Transport Module or MSAM software load. When the load reaches
100%, the Main screen appears. The Transport Module or MSAM is launched; proceed to
step 3.
– If the Transport Module or MSAM was not launched during your last test session (when you
turned the power OFF), the JDSU BERT MODULES STARTUP screen appears, instructing
you to press the SYSTEM/HOME button. Proceed to step 2.
2 Press the SYSTEM/HOME button.
The System screen appears (see Figure 42). The Transport Module or MSAM is represented
by a BERT icon. If you purchased the optical jitter/wander test option for the
Transport Module, a separate JITTER icon is also available. The BERT function or optical
jitter/wander test function can be toggled on and off by selecting the corresponding icon. If a
function is on, the icon is highlighted in yellow. If a function is off, the icon is grey.
– To use the BERT function or test electrical jitter/wander, turn on the BERT icon.
– To test optical jitter or wander, turn on the JITTER icon (would display right next to BERT
icon).
NOTE:
If you purchased the optical jitter/wander test option, turning on the JITTER icon also turns on
the BERT function. If you are no longer testing optical jitter or wander, to conserve the energy,
you can optionally turn off the JITTER icon while still running the BERT function.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
56 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Launching the Transport Module or MSAM

Figure 42 Transport Module System Screen

3 If the icon for the function you want to launch is not already outlined in green, select the icon
by doing one of the following:
– Use the touch screen to select the icon.
– Use the arrow key to select the icon.
The icon is highlighted in green when selected.
4 After the icon is selected (highlighted in green), do one of the following to turn the module ON.
– Use the touch screen to select the icon a second time.
– Press the Enter key.
The interface highlights the icon in yellow, and the Transport Module or MSAM launches.
5 Press the RESULTS button.
The JDSU BERT MODULES STARTUP screen appears, indicating how far the Transport
(BERT) Module or MSAM software load has progressed. When the load reaches 100%, the
Main screen appears.
The Transport Module or MSAM is launched.

NOTE:
After you launch the Transport Module or MSAM, you can use the SYSTEM/HOME button at any
time to return to the System screen to change settings (such as the screen saver). Pressing the
SETUP or RESULTS button will then return you to the corresponding application screen.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 57
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Navigating the user interface

Navigating the user interface


The user interface lets you set up the instrument, configure tests, and display test results. See
Figure 43.

Group Test Battery Category


Indicator

Menu Bar

Message Bar

Quick Config

LED Panel

Actions Panel

Result Window Soft keys

Figure 43 Main screen (Ethernet application)

For descriptions of the physical control buttons on the front panel of the base unit, refer to the 8000
Base Unit User Manual or the 6000A Base Unit User Manual.

Kinetic scrolling and gestures (5800v2 only)


If using the T‐BERD / MTS 5800v2, the UI operates similar to a mobile device (such as an iPad or 
similar Android device), where you swipe to go to the next page or zoom in/out with pinching or 
opening your fingers.

Menu Bar
The menu bar provides the following menus:

Test
Use the options listed on the Test menu to select your test application.

For example, to transmit patterns in a STS-48c Bulk BERT payload over an OC-48 circuit, select:

Test> SONET> OC-48 > STS-48c Bulk BERT > Terminate

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
58 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Navigating the user interface

View
Use the options listed on the View menu to change the format of the Main screen. Options are
provided which allow you to change the result layout and hide or display a variety of items on the
Main screen, such as the Message bar, LED panel, Signal Structure (graphical display), and the
Actions panel. An option is also available which allows you to toggle between tests running on
different ports.

Reports
Use the options on the Reports menu to create, view, and export custom reports for your module.
You can also enable and configure automatic reports using the Automatic Reports option.

Tools
Use the options on the Tools menu to import or export saved test configurations, set up your module
to emulate the FST-2000 TestPad or ANT platform LEDs, and to activate new test options on your
module. The Clear History option clears all historical LEDs.

Help
Use the Help menu to launch a help system with each of the topics discussed in the testing manual,
or to view signal connections.

Soft keys
The soft keys located on the right side of the graphical user interface provide quick access to setup
screens and the result display.

Setup/Results
The top key (Setup/Results) is used to toggle between the Setup screens and the Main (Result)
screen. When the Main screen is displayed, the Setup key appears; when the setup screens are
displayed, the Results key appears.

A Restart soft key is also provided which allows you to restart a test (and clear results). Additional
soft keys appear when appropriate for the test application you select. For example, if you select a
Layer 4 Multiple Streams Ethernet application, a Toolkit soft key is provided which allows you to
run a variety of scripts designed to simplify testing.

For descriptions of setup parameters, refer to the testing manual for your instrument.

Menu Keys
The seven menu keys located on the right side of the front panel perform the same functions as the
softkeys immediately to their left on the graphical user interface. If your unit does not have a touch
screen, use these buttons to access the setup screens, restart tests, and perform other functions
specific to your test application.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 59
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Navigating the user interface

Message Bar
The message bar displays the current test application selected on the unit. For example, if you
selected the Layer 4 Multiple Streams application for a 10GigE LAN circuit, the following application
appears in the message bar:

10GigE LAN Layer 4 Streams Term

If your instrument is configured with two ports for a particular rate, the currently selected port also
appears at the beginning of the message.

Various other messages may appear briefly, for example, to alert you that loop ups are successful.
You can display a log of messages by selecting the arrows in the bar.

Quick Config settings


After you select a test application (using the Test menu), a Quick Config tab appears under the
Message Bar, with key settings required to configure your test. For example, if you selected the
SONET -> OC-192 -> OC-192c Bulk BERT - > Terminate application, quick configuration settings
appear that allow you to automatically detect and insert a BERT pattern. See Figure 44.

Figure 44 Quick Config Settings

Signal Structure
If you are running a SONET, SDH, or OTN application, a Signal Structure tab appears to the right
of the Quick Config tab. When selected, the tab shows the structure of the signal transmitted from
the unit to the device under test (DUT) and then to another device on the far end of the circuit (typi-
cally another test instrument). Figure 45 illustrates the signal structure when you transmit a Bulk
BERT payload in an STS-48c signal carried in an OTU1 OTN wrapper.

Figure 45 OTU1 2.7G STS-48c Bulk BERT signal structure

LED Panel
The LEDs in the panel to the left of the Results Windows help you determine whether a signal is
present, pattern synchronization has been achieved, and other key events when performing tests.

You can collapse and expand an LED panel by tapping the panel name (for example, SONET).

When you set up the Transport Module or MSAM, you can indicate that the LEDs should emulate
those displayed on the user interface of the FST-2000 TestPad or the ANT platform.

– For instructions on customizing the LED panel, see “Customizing the user interface look and
feel” on page 66.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
60 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Navigating the user interface

– For descriptions of each of the LEDs, refer to the Test Results chapter in the testing manual
that shipped with your instrument.

Current and history LEDs


The round LEDs on the inside column provide the current state of the key event; the square LEDs
on the outside column provide the historical state (in other words, the event occurred in the past).

LED colors
Green LEDs indicate an event occurred as expected, yellow LEDs indicate that an event occurred
that warrants additional investigation, and red LEDs indicate that an error, anomaly, alarm, or defect
has occurred.

LEDs for muxed payloads


When testing muxed payloads, panels appear for each of the payloads (in addition to the LEDs for
the interface rate). For example, if you are testing an E1 BERT payload carried in a DS3 signal, a
DS3 panel and a E1 panel appear.

10 Gigabit Ethernet WAN LEDs


When testing 10 Gigabit Ethernet WAN circuits, a SONET or SDH panel and an Ethernet panel
appear.

Actions Panel
After you select a test application (using the Test menu), an Actions Panel appears under the LED
display that provides tabs with the buttons required to perform your test. The buttons available vary
depending on the test application you select. For example, buttons may appear that allow you to
start and stop transmitting Ethernet traffic, start and stop a local loopback, or, if you selected a
SONET application, allow you to specify error, anomaly, alarm, defect, and pointer parameters for
the test.

A blinking circle on a tab indicates that some action is required on your part. For example, if you are
running a BERT test, the Actions tab may blink indicating that you need to start transmitting the
BERT pattern.

If you select a test application for an optical rate, a


Laser / Tx Signal tab also appears, with buttons that allow you to select an SFP connector for the
test (if appropriate), specify the transmitted wavelength (for OC-192, STM-64, OTU-2, and
10 Gigabit Ethernet and Fibre Channel signals), and turn the laser on and off. See Figure 46.

Figure 46 Laser buttons (OC-3 application)

If you do not see the buttons that you need to perform a test, select View > Actions Panel on the
Menu Bar, and then select the tab with the buttons that you need.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 61
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Navigating the user interface

You can also hide the Action Panel on the Main screen by clearing the View > Actions Panel selec-
tion.

NOTE:
The color of a button reflects its current state. Action buttons are highlighted in yellow when they
are turned on; they are grey when they are off.

Result Buttons
Group and Category buttons are provided at the top of each result window. The Group button on
the left allows you to select the type of results you want to observe (for example, Summary results);
the Category button on the right allows you to select a specific results category for the group you
specified. By selecting a different group or category for each pane, you can view multiple sets of
results at the same time. See Figure 47.

Group Category

Figure 47 Result Buttons (SONET application)

Result Windows
The test results appear in Result Windows (see Figure 48).

Figure 48 Result Window (Ethernet application)

Errors are highlighted in red; other results appear in black.

You can change the layout of the Result Windows using options provided on the View menu. You
can also choose to show just test results on the main screen by selecting View > Show Only
Results.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
62 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Setting up the instrument

For test result descriptions, refer to the Test Results chapter in the T-BERD/MTS 8000 and T-BERD/
MTS 6000A Transport Module and Multiple Services Application Module Testing Guide.

Setting up the instrument


Setting up the instrument involves loading new software upgrades or options, setting up the screen
saver, specifying a printer for the instrument, and indicating whether you want your LEDs displayed
using the format used on the FST-2000 TestPad format, or the format used on the ANT platform.

The System menu provides access to regional settings, the date and time, and adjusting display
settings. For the Transport Module and Multiple Services Application Module, refer to the 8000
Base Unit User Manual or 6000A Base Unit User Manual. The T-BERD / MTS 5800 system menu
shown in Figure 49.

Figure 49 T-BERD / MTS 5800 System Menu

Specifying international settings


Before testing, you can specify the language and the date and time format for the user interface.

To specify international settings


1 Select the SYSTEM/HOME icon.
The System screen appears.
2 Do one of the following:
a T-BERD / MTS 5800
i Select Region.
ii The System Setup screen appears, listing settings that control the appearance
and behavior of your unit.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 63
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Setting up the instrument

iii In the Language box, select the language for the user interface.
The formatting standard changes automatically.
iv In the Samples for selected formatting box, the date, time, and number format-
ting appear.
v If you want to change the formatting standard, click the Change formatting stan-
dard box, and then select a country.
vi If you wish to do so, click the check box next to Use 24-hour time.
vii Turn the instrument off then back on.
The user interface changes to the language you specified.
b T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800
i Press System Setup.
The System Setup screen appears, listing settings that control the appearance and
behavior of your unit.
ii Select Language, and then select the language for the user interface.
iii Select Date Format, and then select the mm/dd/yyyy or dd/mm/yyyy format.
iv Select Time Format, and then select the 24 hour clock or 12 hour clock format.
A message appears indicating that you need to reboot the unit for the settings to
take effect.
v Press the ON/OFF button to turn the unit OFF, and then press it again to turn the
unit back ON.
The unit reboots in the language you specified.
International settings are specified.

Setting the date and time

MSAM and Transport Module


You can change the date and time on your instrument by editing the system settings, and then
rebooting your module. For instructions on changing the date and time, refer to the 8000 Base Unit
User Manual or 6000A Base Unit User Manual.

T-BERD / MTS 5800


The T-BERD / MTS 5800 has an internal clock that you can set to provide accurate time stamps for
test results.

To set the date and time


1 Select the SYSTEM/HOME icon.
The System screen appears.
2 Select Date and Time.
3 Specify the Region, Country, and Area, and if you wish to do so, click the check box for Auto-
matically adjust for daylight savings time.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
64 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Setting up the instrument

4 Under Current Date & Time, do the following:


a Use the up and down arrows to specify the current local time. If you wish to do so, click
the check box next to Use 24-hour time.
b Use the calendar to select the current date.

Checking the battery


You can check the status of the battery in two ways:

Method 1 — The battery status indicator in the upper right corner of the screen provides a graphic indication
of the approximate battery charge.
Battery Indicator

Method 2 — The Battery Level percentage on the Battery status page.

1 Select the SYSTEM icon.


2 Select Battery.
The battery status appears.
3 View the Battery Level.
The Battery Status page indicates the charge level (both in percentage under the battery and
the color of the battery), whether the adapter is plugged in, and indicates the battery temper-
ature range.

Setting up the display


Setting up the display includes setting the screen brightness and setting up the screen saver.

NOTE:
The Display menu also allows calibration of the touchscreen. See “Calibrating the touchscreen”
on page 118.

Adjusting screen brightness


The following procedure describes how to adjust the screen brightness.

To adjust the screen brightness


1 Select the SYSTEM icon.
2 Select Display.
3 Change the brightness level by moving the slider left or right.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 65
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Setting up the instrument

Setting up the screen saver


If you are operating the instrument using the battery, you should set up the screen saver to switch
off the screen automatically after the unit has not been used for a specific interval of time. For
instructions on setting up the screen saver on a MSAM or Transport Module, refer to the 8000 Base
Unit User Manual or 6000A Base Unit User Manual. For the T-BERD / MTS 5800, see below.

To set up the screen saver


1 Select the SYSTEM icon, and then select Display.
2 To enable the screen saver, click the check box next to Enable automatic screen saver.
3 To change the message displayed as a screen saver, click in the Message field, and then enter
the message.
4 To specify the time to wait until the screen saver begins, do the following:
a Click on the drop down next to the Delay field, and then specify the time unit, for
example, seconds, minutes or hours.
b Click in the Delay field. A keyboard appears. Enter the amount of time, and then click
OK. For example, if you selected minutes in the previous step, enter the number of
minutes of delay.
5 Click the check box next to Screen saver password if you wish to enable a screen saver pass-
word (a password is required to close the screen saver and resume using the instrument).
Make a note of the password and put it somewhere safe.
The screen saver is setup.

Customizing the user interface look and feel


You can set up the T-BERD / MTS 5800, Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM to
emulate the FST-2000 TestPad user interface (TestPad mode), or the ANT platform user interface
(ANT mode). This primarily impacts the LED result format on the Main screen.

TestPad mode
If you specify TestPad mode for the LED display, the inside green LEDs illuminate sequentially as
key events occur, such as signal detection, frame synchronization, and pattern synchronization.
The Status LED illuminates green if all summary results are OK. If the test stops, the Status LED is
locked until you start or restart the test.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
66 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Setting up the instrument

Figure 50 illustrates the LED panel for a SONET application in TestPad mode.

Status LEDs

Alarm LEDs

Figure 50 SONET LED Panel in TestPad mode

If the module loses any of the LED events, the green Status LED extinguishes, and the red Alarm
LED in the history column illuminates indicating an error condition has occurred. For example, if the
module detected a signal, but then loses it, the green Signal Present LED extinguishes, and the red
LED in the history column illuminates. If the module then regains a signal, the green Signal Present
LED illuminates, and the red history LED stays illuminated until you clear history results or restart
the test.

ANT mode
If you specify ANT mode for the LED display, the LEDs illuminate red when key events or errors
occur. For example, if the module does not detect a signal, the associated LOS LED illuminates.
When the module detects a signal, the LOS LED extinguishes.

Figure 51 illustrates the LED panel for a SONET application in ANT mode.

Figure 51 SONET LED Panel in ANT mode

Specifying the LED results mode

To specify the LED results mode


1 Launch the Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM.
The Main screen appears.
2 Select Tools > Customize.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 67
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Setting up the instrument

The Customize User Interface Look and Feel screen appears.

3 Select the arrow keys to the right of the Result/Setup Terminology field, and then select ANT
or TestPad mode.
4 Select Close to store the result mode and return to the Main screen.
The test results mode is specified.

Viewing or installing options


Your instrument may come with software options installed or you may order them later and install
yourself.

To view installed options


– On the menu bar, select Tools>Review/Install Options.
The Software Options screen appears.

The icon indicates whether the option is enabled.

Icon Indicates

Option is enabled.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
68 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Setting up the instrument

Icon Indicates

An expiring option. An “expiring option” is an option that is installed for free for a trial period.
The time left in the trial is indicated to the right. When the trial period ends, a warning mes-
sage appears. If you are running a test when the option expires, you can continue testing, but
the expiration warning will reappear every minute until you either enter a permanent option
key or reset the module (changing applications will reset the module).

Option has not been enabled. If you need this option, contact JDSU Customer Care to place
an order.

To install software options


– Refer to the Software Option Installation Instruction provided with the option.

Loading upgrades
Software upgrades can be loaded from storage media such as a CD-ROM or a USB memory key.
To obtain the latest software release for your unit, contact your local JDSU sales office.

Refer to the instructions provided with the software upgrades for details.

Synchronizing to the StrataSync server


To automatically obtain the latest configuration settings, software options, updates and ownership
registration information, the T-BERD / MTS 5800, T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800 may be
synchronized with a JDSU server via the internet with an optional subscription-based service called
StrataSync.

In addition to the latest operating software, the synchronization also stores any user files saved to
the unit’s hard drive on the StrataSync server. A connection to the internet would be provided upon
receipt of the unit and on a regular (daily) basis thereafter to ensure that it has the most currently
issued options and updates and to allow all user information to be backed up.

If an internet connection is available and contact has been made with the StrataSync server, a
message appears asking you to initiate the syncing process.

NOTE:
Before attempting to synchronize the unit to the StrataSync server, be certain that no applica-
tions are currently utilizing the RJ-45 Management port.

To sync with the StrataSync Server

1 Verify that the server ID is displayed in the Server ID field -default= stratasync.jdsu.com
2 Enter the Account ID for this unit. No synchronization can occur without the entry of a pre-
approved, unique ID number. This ID must be obtained from JDS before attempting to sync to
the server.
3 If desired, enter the Tech ID. This will be populated by a default value (default = 6000 Tech)
but may be changed to identify the user initiating the synchronization.
4 Press the Synchronize button.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 69
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Setting up the instrument

To halt the synchronization process after it has been started, select the Stop Sync button.
NOTE:
During Synchronization, a cloud icon will be displayed at the top of the screen and the state of
the synchronization activities will be displayed below the Synchronize button. The cloud icon will
also be modified to indicate the following actions -
Up/Downloading- Cloud with arrows
Failed Sync - Cloud with ed X overlay
Sync Success - Cloud with green check mark
If an error or failure occurs, a message detailing the possible reason for the problem will be dis-
played in the status message under the Start button.

The synchronization process includes:

– After syncing with the StrataSync server, the unit sends identifying information about the hard-
ware and software that currently comprise the unit.
If the configuration information contained on the server is newer than that on the unit, the
server will be considered to be the most up-to-date.
NOTE:
StrataSync may have difficulty determining the newest file if the system time of the unit has been
modified.

– If the server finds files that are newer than those on the unit, the server sends the files to the
unit.
Each time the synchronization process modifies or copies files, a message appears indicating
the action just taken.
– The unit will then send any reports, configuration profiles, screen shots, and similar files that
have been saved on the unit since the last configuration. Table 8 provides the file names that
may be included.

Reports Configurations

*.txt *.tst

*.csv *.dualtst

*.pdf *.ams

*.xml *.sam

*.html *.truespeed

*.png *.expert_rfc

*.pcap *.cat

*.xml

Table 8 File types sent to StrataSync server.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
70 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Preparing for optical testing

– The server then applies any applicable Options to the unit.


NOTE:
If an Option Code was entered as a part of synchronization, the MSAM must be restarted to
complete the process and initialize the option.
Anytime an option is updated, the unit will conclude the update process by attempting to contact
the StrataSync server. If a connection is unavailable, one should be provide at the earliest con-
venience to register all installed options.

– Lastly, if any upgrades are available, the user will be informed of their availability and asked to
verify their desire to receive the upgrade.
– When synchronization is complete, the Status will indicate “Status Complete” and the unit will
reboot. The unit may be disconnected from the internet.
The unit has been synchronized to the StrataSync Server

Specifying a printer for the instrument


After specifying a printer for the instrument, you can print the following for the currently running test
application:

– The display
– The setup parameters
– The test results

To specify a printer for the instrument


1 Press the SYSTEM/HOME button.
2 Select the System Setup softkey.
3 In the Printer box, select Printer, and then select the type of printer you are connecting to the
unit. If you select a USB printer, you can then select the manufacturer for the printer.
The printer is specified. For instructions on connecting a printer to the base unit, refer to the 8000
Base Unit User Manual or 6000A Base Unit User Manual.

Preparing for optical testing


Before testing on optical circuits using the T-BERD / MTS 5800, Transport Module or MSAM, you
should be familiar with the following items.

Considerations
Before testing on optical circuits using the Transport Module or MSAM, consider the following:

– Only use the SFPs that shipped with your instrument, or SFPs purchased from JDSU as acces-
sories. A list of JDSU supported optics (transceivers) shipped with your instrument.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 71
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Preparing for optical testing

– Details concerning the SFP used for the currently selected application are available on the
Interface setup tab.

WARNING: HAZARDOUS LIGHT EXPOSURE


Do not look directly into the optical output of the unit or at the output of any optical cable or trans-
ceiver connected to the unit. If a fiber optic cable is removed from a transmitting connector or
transceiver, cover the connector with the safety cap to prevent inadvertent exposure to the laser
output.

WARNING: RISK OF DAMAGE TO TRANSCEIVERS


When connecting the instrument to optical circuits using an SFP or XFP, do not apply optical
power that exceeds the maximum optical power published as permitted by the transceiver manu-
facturer.
If you do not know the optical power of the applied signal, use an attenuator when you connect to
the circuit for the first time, then remove the attenuator if you determine that it was not necessary.
Otherwise, the transceiver can be permanently damaged due to the “hot signal”.
A variety of attenuators are available for purchase as options when you order your instrument.

Tuning XFPs
The ITU-T G.694.2 standard provides a frequency grid for DWDM which creates channel spacing
from 12.5 GHz to 100 GHz. The channel spacing allows different carriers to run on the same fiber.
Using a tunable XFP in our instrument, you can use different channels or wavelengths. Most XFPs
are designed for C-band wavelengths.

To tune a XFP
1 Verify whether your XFP supports tuning by viewing the Connector Setup.

This screen varies depending on the XFP device.


The first two lines under the XFP tab relate to the tunable characteristics of the XFP. The first
indicates that the XFP is tunable, and may show which wavelengths are tunable. The second
line indicates which types of tuning are supported.
2 Do one of the following:
a To specify the tuning in the Setup menu, do the following:
– Select the Signal tab.
– Select the Tuning Mode: Channel, Wavelength or Frequency.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
72 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Preparing for optical testing

– If you selected Wavelength, specify the wavelength. The available wavelength range
appears. If you selected Channel, specify the channel. The available channel range
appears.
If you selected Frequency, specify the freqency. The value entered will be converted and
the available wavelength and/or channel ranges appear.
If the XFP being tuned is capable of channel-only or wavelength-only tuning, the user
selected value will be translated to the appropriate value and tuning method respectively.
If the device is tunable by both wavelength and channel, the software will determine the
closest channel (50 GHz spacing) and wavelength(50 nm spacing) value. The tuning
method with the smallest difference to the user selected value will be used to tune the
XFP.
b To specify the tuning on the Result screen, do the following:
– Press the Result soft key.
– Use the Laser action buttons to specify the Tuning Mode: Frequency, Wavelength or
Channel.

Figure 52 XFP connector properties

If you selected Wavelength, click on the wavelength field, and use the keypad to enter the
wavelength.
If you selected Channel, click on the channel field, and use the keypad to enter the
channel.
If you selected Frequency, specify the frequency. The value entered will be converted and
the available wavelength and/or channel ranges appear.
If the XFP being tuned is capable of channel only or wavelength only tuning, the user
selected value will be translated to the appropriate value and tuning method respectively.
If the device is tunable by both wavelength and channel, the software will determine the
closest channel (50 GHz spacing) and wavelength(50 nm spacing) value. The tuning
method with the smallest difference to the user selected value will be used to tune the
XFP.
The XFP is tuned.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 73
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Testing 40G/100G Optics

Testing 40G/100G Optics


The Optics Self-test is available for all 40G/100G interfaces to allow the user to verify the proper
operation and stability of the CFP,CFP2, or QSFP+ connected to their 40G/100G Transport Module
or CSAM. The Optics Self-Test appears on all interface selection options as the topmost entry in
the list and is named Optics Self-Test.

The test verifies signal presence, level (at all possible rates), and rejection of excessive skew. It also
allows a user-specified BER threshold and a maximum Offset (in PPM).

Running the Optics Self-Test

To run the optics self-test


1 If you haven’t already done so, use the Test Menu to select the Optical Self-Test application
for the interface you are testing.
2 Specify the test settings.
– Test Duration
– BER Threshold
– Maximum offset (in PPM)
– Stop on Error – If enabled, the test stops immediately upon discovery of an out-of-parameter
result.
NOTE:
The recommended test times are calculated using BER theory based on the following:
– confidence level (CL) set to 95%
– the user-defined BER threshold
– the duration depends on the line rate selected from the applications menu

3 Connect an optical cable between the interface input and output ports.
4 Select the Test CFP Optics or Test QSFP+ Optics soft key (depending upon which optic is to
be tested).
As the test runs, the current status of test values appear.
The Optics Self-test has been initiated.

Generating a report
After running the Optics Self-test, you can generate a report of the results.

To generate a report
1 After the Optics Self-test has concluded, select the Next arrow at the bottom of the screen.
The Test Complete screen appears.
2 Select the desired report format.
3 Do one of the following:
– To view the report without saving it, select View Report.
– To save a report, do the following:

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
74 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Connecting the Transport Module to the circuit

a Enter the filename of the report to be save.


File names of other saved reports are accessible via the Select button after the File Name
box.
b Select Create Report.
If the View Report after Creation check box was checked, the report appears. Go to
step 4.
If not checked, a message appears confirming the report was saved. Select OK
4 Select OK to return to the report screen.

Connecting the Transport Module to the circuit


Before connecting the Transport Module to the circuit for testing, if you haven’t already done so,
assemble the instrument. Refer to the following procedures for assembly instructions:

– “Connecting a Transport Module or DMC to a base unit” on page 32


– If you are connecting to an optical circuit, see “Inserting a SFP/SFP+, XFP or QSFP+ trans-
ceiver” on page 43
When connecting the instrument to optical circuits, consider the following:

– If you intend to test optical circuits, you need to insert an SFP, XFP, QSFP+, CFP or attach an
external optical connector to the appropriate connector on your chassis.
– Older chassis provide internal optical connectors for all circuits.
– The new Version 3 chassis provides connectors for swappable SFPs when testing OC-3/12/48,
STM-1/4/16,
GigE/100FX, OTU-1, or 1/2/4G FC circuits, providing greater flexibility as you test different
circuits.
– All chassis configured for OC-192/STM-64/OTU-2/10 GigE/10 Gig FC testing provide internal
optical connectors on the 10G port.
– If you chose an OC-3/12/48 SONET, STM-1/4/16 SDH,
GigE/100 FX Ethernet, or 1/2/4G Fibre Channel signal when you selected your test application,
and your Transport Module chassis provides SFP connectors, you must indicate which SFP
connector you are using for the test.

To connect the Transport Module to the circuit


1 If you are testing an optical circuit, do the following:
– If you have a Version 3 chassis, and you are testing an OC-3/12/48, STM-1/4/16, OTU-1,
GigE/100FX, or
1/2/4 FC circuit, verify that the appropriate SFP for your test is inserted in the connector that
you intend to use for your test.
If an SFP is already inserted, verify that it supports your application by specifying the
connector number (SFP1, SFP2, SFP3, or SFP4) as the Connector setting on the Main
screen, and then displaying the Interface tab. The SFP ID, vendor, revision, and rates
supported are provided on the tab.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 75
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Connecting the Transport Module to the circuit

If an SFP is not inserted, specify the Connector setting. A yellow LED under the connector
for the SFP blinks. Insert the correct SFP for your circuit (see “Inserting a SFP/SFP+, XFP
or QSFP+ transceiver” on page 43).
– If you have a Version 1 or Version 2 chassis, or if you are testing an OC-192, STM-64, OTU-
2, 10GigE, or 10G FC circuit, verify that the appropriate optical connector is connected to
the correct internal connector on the panel. If you need to attach an optical connector, see
“Attaching an external optical connector” on page 47.
If appropriate for your module, specify the wavelength as the Connector setting on the
Main screen. If your module only supports one wavelength (850 nm, 1310 nm or 1550
nm), the wavelength settings on the Main screen and Interface tab are disabled.
2 Select the correct cable for the connection:
– For 1310nm and 1550nm connections, use a single mode fiber optic cable.
– For 850nm connections, use a multi mode fiber optic cable.
– For 10/100/1000BaseT connections, use an Ethernet cross-over cable.
– For DS1 connections, use a Bantam cable.
– For E1 (2M) connections, use a BNC or RJ-45 cable.
– For DS3, E3, STS-1, E4, and STM-1e connections, use a BNC cable.
See Figure 6 on page 16 and Figure 7 on page 17 for illustrations of the connector panel.
3 Using the blinking yellow LEDs and labels on the connector panel as a guide, connect one
end of the cable to the appropriate connector for your test, and then connect the other end to
the circuit under test. If you are connecting to an optical circuit, be certain to attenuate the
signal.
NOTE: If your connector panel provides dual ports, flashing LEDs indicate which connectors
are used for the currently selected test; solid LEDs indicate the connectors used for other
tests.
4 If you connected to an optical circuit, determine whether you can remove the attenuator by
observing the Optical Rx Level (dBm) result in the Interface group, Signal category. If
attenuation is not necessary, remove the attenuator, reconnect the cable to the transceiver,
and then press Restart.
The Transport Module is connected to the circuit.

Configuring Expert settings


The optics used in the CSAM and 40/100G High Speed Transport Module ideally auto-configure
upon insertion and therefore require no user intervention.

For applications where configuration of the optics is critical, an Expert configuration is provided.
This function provides adjustments for the optics to compensate for equipment variations and trans-
mission conditions.

To configure expert settings


1 From the main menu, select the Setup soft key. A series of setup tabs appear.
2 On the Interface tab, select the Connector tab.
3 Select the Expert Configuration tab.
4 Click the box to Enable Expert Mode.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
76 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Connecting the Transport Module to the circuit

With exception of the QSFP+ Latency Offset, the expert mode parameters are only applicable
to CFP modules. The settings will only appear if a valid non-loopback CFP or QSFP+ has
been inserted.
5 Adjust the Transmit (Tx) settings as applicable:
a Specify the Pre-Emphasis setting.

Setting Description

Default Original manufacturer settings.

Low Some pre-emphasis is applied.

Nominal A moderate level of pre-emphasis is applied. This is the ideal setting for most CFPs.

High A high level of pre-emphasis is applied.

The default pre-emphasis settings are set to values which are recommended to work with
all optics on the Recommended Optics List.
b Specify the Clock Divider setting.

Setting Description

Default Original manufacturer settings.

1/16 The reference clock will be set to 1/16 of the CAU line rate.

1/64 The reference clock will be set to 1/64 of the CAU line rate.

The default reference clock will be set to the default mode that the CFP is expecting.
c Specify the Skew Offset.
The Synchronous Transport Lane (STL) specification requires 32-byte lane spacing but
some serial CFP hardware exists that does not conform to this specification. The CSAM
and 40/100G Transport Module are being shipped with a CFP Skew value at -32. If, at a
later time, hardware changes require it, a skew value of 32 is also available.
The Skew settings appear only for SONET applications when using single-lambda CFPs.
d Specify whether to Invert Polarity.
This inverts the polarity of the data from the FPGA transceiver to the CFP. This is a special
case feature that may be necessary for use with electrical-breakout or other evaluation
CFPs.
e Specify whether to reset the FIFO on the transmit path (Reset Tx FIFO) of the CFP.
This button appears only if the CFP has indicated that is supports FIFO manual
reset.Errors may be recorded after a FIFO reset. To clear the errors, restart the test after
resetting the FIFO.
If the unit is looped back to itself, reset the Tx FIFO before resetting the Rx FIFO.
f If you are using an OpNext 100G LR4 CFP, specify whether to automatically reset the
FIFO any time it has regained synchronization (lock) after having lost it.
This is specific to the OpNext 100G LR4 CFP. Per the manufacturer's recommendation,
the 40G/100G Transport Module can execute software-monitored and assisted resets of
the transmit and receive FIFO.
This automatic FIFO-resetting mechanism will be gated (blocked) if
- SONET/SDH service disruption is enabled
- OTN service disruption is enabled
- Ethernet SD has decoupled TX from RX

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 77
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Connecting the MSAM to the circuit

The manual FIFO reset (specified in step e) on the expert configuration page will not be
blocked or gated.
6 Adjust the Receive (Rx) settings as applicable:
a Specify the Equalization setting.

Setting Description

Default Original manufacturer settings.

Low Minimal equalization is applied. This is the ideal setting for most CFPs.

Nominal A moderate level of equalization is applied.

High A high level of equalization is applied.

The default Equalization settings are set to values which are recommended to work with
all optics on the Recommended Optics List.
b Specify whether to activate Invert Polarity.
This inverts the polarity of the data from the CFP to the FPGA transceiver. This is a special
case feature that may be necessary for use with electrical-breakout or other evaluation
CFPs.
c Specify whether to reset the FIFO on the receive path (Reset Rx FIFO) of the CFP.
These buttons appear only if the CFP has indicated that is supports FIFO manual
reset.Errors may be recorded after a FIFO reset. To clear the errors, restart the test after
resetting the FIFO.
If the unit is looped back to itself, reset the Tx FIFO before resetting the Rx FIFO.
d If you are using an OpNext 100G LR4 CFP, specify whether to automatically reset the
FIFO any time it has regained synchronization (lock) after having lost it.
This is specific to the OpNext 100G LR4 CFP. Per the manufacturer's recommendation,
the 40G/100G Transport Module can execute software-monitored and assisted resets of
the transmit and receive FIFO.
This automatic FIFO-resetting mechanism will be gated (blocked) if
- SONET/SDH service disruption is enabled
- OTN service disruption is enabled
- Ethernet SD has decoupled TX from RX
The manual FIFO reset (specified in step c) on the expert configuration page will not be
blocked or gated.
The Optics Expert Mode parameters are set.

Connecting the MSAM to the circuit


Before connecting the MSAM to the circuit for testing, if you haven’t already done so, assemble the
instrument. Refer to the following procedures for assembly instructions:

– “Inserting MSAMs or CSAMs into the 6000A base unit or DMC” on page 39
– “Inserting a PIM into the MSAM” on page 41
– If you are connecting to an optical circuit, see “Inserting a SFP/SFP+, XFP or QSFP+ trans-
ceiver” on page 43

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
78 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Connecting the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 to the circuit

To connect the instrument to the circuit


1 If you are testing on an optical circuit, insert the appropriate SFP or XFP into the PIM (see
“Inserting a SFP/SFP+, XFP or QSFP+ transceiver” on page 43).
2 Select the cable for the circuit. When selecting the cable, consider the following:
– Are you testing an electrical or optical circuit?
– If you are testing an optical circuit, is it a single-mode or multi-mode circuit? Do you have
the appropriate attenuator for the cable?
– What type of connectors are required? For example, if you are connecting to the circuit from
a device with LC connectors, you can use an LC to LC cable.
3 Connect one end of the selected cable to the appropriate transceiver or jack on your instru-
ment, and then connect the other end to the device on the circuit. If you are connecting to an
optical circuit, be certain to attenuate the signal.
4 If you connected to an optical circuit, determine whether you can remove the attenuator by
observing the Optical Rx Level (dBm) result in the Interface group, Signal category. If
attenuation is not necessary, remove the attenuator, reconnect the cable to the transceiver,
and then press Restart.
The MSAM is connected to the circuit.

Connecting the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 to the circuit


When connecting the instrument to the circuit, these basic steps should be followed.

To connect the instrument to the circuit


1 If you are testing on an optical circuit, insert the appropriate SFP or XFP (see “Inserting an SFP
or XFP transceiver” on page 28).
2 Select the cable for the circuit. When selecting the cable, consider the following:
– Are you testing an electrical or optical circuit?
– If you are testing an optical circuit, is it a single-mode or multi-mode circuit? Do you have
the appropriate attenuator for the cable?
– What type of connectors are required? For example, if you are connecting to the circuit from
a device with LC connectors, you can use an LC to LC cable.
3 Connect one end of the selected cable to the appropriate transceiver or jack on your instru-
ment, and then connect the other end to the device on the circuit. If you are connecting to an
optical circuit, be certain to attenuate the signal.
4 If you connected to an optical circuit, determine whether you can remove the attenuator by
observing the Optical Rx Level (dBm) result in the Interface group, Signal category. If
attenuation is not necessary, remove the attenuator, reconnect the cable to the transceiver, and
then press Restart.
The T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 is connected to the circuit.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 79
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Connecting the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 to the circuit

Browsing the web


The T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800v2 includes a web browser similar to that found on a tablet. Although it is
not expected to perform in all aspects like that of a browser on a PC, it will allow access to a
company intra-net or work order system as well as access to JDSU web resources on the instru-
ment. It runs over the Ethernet management interface.

NOTE:
You need access to the internet for the web browser to function properly.

To browse the web


1 Press the System button.
2 Select Web Browser.
The Browser launches

Connecting to WiFi
The T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800v2 includes internal WiFi. (T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800v1 required an external
dongle.)

To connect to WiFi
1 Press the System button.
2 Select Network, and then click Wi-Fi on the left side of the screen.
3 Check the “Enable wireless adapter” box.

4 Select a wireless network to connect to.


If it is a private network, a lock icon appears. You must enter the correct password to access
the private network.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
80 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Playing videos

Playing videos
The T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800v2 includes a video player. It can be used to play training videos, adver-
tisements, or other videos. You can access videos from USB or the file system. The player supports
AVI, MP4, H.265/MPEG-4 video formats.

To play videos
1 Press the System button.
2 Select Video Player.
The Player launches
3 Press the Open File button
4 Browse to find the video file.
5 Click Open.
The video plays.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 81
Chapter 3 Getting Started
Playing videos

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
82 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
4
Chapter 4 Basic Testing

This chapter explains basic testing concepts and procedures common to each test. Topics
discussed in this chapter include the following:

– “Step 1: Selecting a test application” on page 84


– “Step 2: Configuring a test” on page 86
– “Step 3: Connecting the instrument to the circuit” on page 88
– “Step 4: Starting the test” on page 88
– “Step 5: Viewing test results” on page 89
– “Running multiple tests” on page 95
– “Scheduling timed tests” on page 100
– “Creating and printing reports” on page 100
– “Restoring test defaults” on page 105
– “VT-100 emulation” on page 105
– “HTML Viewer” on page 107

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 83
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Step 1: Selecting a test application

Step 1: Selecting a test application


The Test menu lists each of the available test applications for the currently installed options and
configuration of the unit. The Quick Launch list can be used for frequently run tests to speed up the
test setup.

If you are testing using an MSAM, the applications are listed for the PIMs that are currently inserted
in the MSAM. If you are testing using a Transport Module, the applications are listed for options
installed in your unit.

To select an application
1 Select Test.
The Quick Launch page appears.

To skip this page in the future, and have the Main screen appear, select the Do not show this
screen at startup check box at the bottom of this screen.
2 Select an application from one of the three sections:
– Applications list – Located just under the Test button, the applications list displays the avail-
able applications (for example, SONET, SDH, CPRI). The applications in the list are depen-
dent upon the configuration of the unit. Select the technology (for example, Ethernet),
signal, payload, and test mode for your test application.
– Quick Launch Favorites – Located in the top, center of the screen, the Quick Launch Favor-
ites list provides commonly used applications previously programmed into the unit. This list
can be programmed by the operator and the stored application names may be changed to

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
84 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Step 1: Selecting a test application

custom names and can be moved and combined into groups by selecting the Customize
button. If an application is grayed out, it is not applicable for the current configuration (for
example, if a different PIM has been inserted).

Figure 53 Customize Favorites

Shortcuts can be added to any active application. Saved tests (currently stored in the
memory of the unit) can be added and given a custom name at the time of addition. To
separate groups of favorites, a horizontal separation line can be added between entries.
– Current and Recently Used – Located in the bottom, center of the screen, the Current and
Recently Used list provides a list of the most recently initiated applications, listed in reverse
chronological order. Up to five applications are listed, with the first item being the currently
loaded application. Applications names displayed are the standard application name even if
it had been renamed when saved.
If you wish to add a current or recent application to the Favorites list, click the icon at the
beginning of the application name. Currently running tests may be added to Favorites as
a saved test or a shortcut. Recently used. but not running, tests may only be saved as
shortcuts.
The selections for Quick Launch and Current/Recent are fully qualified applications as
described by the name. For example, Port1: 10/100/1000 Ethernet Layer 2 Term is
for a specific test utilizing defined technology, signals, payload and test mode. If the defined
port is unavailable, but test can be launched on another port, it will be launched on that port.
To return to the Results page of the current application, press the arrow button to the right of its
name.
3 Wait for the Main screen to appear, and then proceed to “Step 2: Configuring a test” on
page 86
The test application is selected.

NOTE:
When testing using an MSAM, only the applications for currently inserted PIMs will appear on
the Test menu. For example, if an SFP and XFP PIM are inserted in the Transport Module chas-
sis, you will not see DS1 applications.
Other applications, such as the Mac-in-Mac or NextGen GFP applications only appear if you
purchased the associated testing options.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 85
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Step 2: Configuring a test

Step 2: Configuring a test


Configuring a test involves displaying the setup screens, specifying test settings, and optionally
saving the test setup.

Key settings are also available on the Main screen, on the Quick Config tabs. Changing key settings
while running a test (for example, changing the pattern transmitted) triggers an automatic restart of
the test.

Displaying the setup screens

To display the setup screens


1 Using the Test menu or Home page, select a test application (see “Step 1: Selecting a test
application” on page 84).
2 Select the Setup soft key.
The setup page appears and typically includes a series of tabs. The tabs displayed vary based
on the test application you selected. See Figure 54.

Figure 54 Setup Screen (Ethernet Settings tab for GFP testing)

3 To navigate to a different setup screen, select the corresponding tab at the top of the screen.
For example, to display the Traffic setup screen, select the Traffic tab.
4 After you finish specifying the test settings (see “Entering data in the setup fields” on
page 87), select the Results soft key to return to the Main screen.

TIP:
If you want to provide a screen shots of a configuration tab (and the settings that you specified
on the tab), on the Main screen, select Tools > Capture Screenshot. A screen shot will be cap-
tured and stored as a JPG file in the
/acterna/user/storage/bert/images folder. You can include the screen shot when you
create reports.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
86 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Step 2: Configuring a test

Entering data in the setup fields


When specifying test settings, you can either select a value from a drop-down menu, or tap the field
to launch a keypad, then type a value.

To select a value from a drop-down menu


– Select the arrow icon to the right of the field, and then highlight the value for the setting.

To type text or numeric values


– Select the field to launch a keypad, type the value, and then select OK.
The value appears in the field.
NOTE:
The valid ranges and values for user-specified settings appear at the top of the keypad. For
example, if you configure a constant traffic load for a 10 GigE LAN circuit, 0.001 .. 100.000
appears at the top of the keypad, indicating that a number ranging from 0.001 to 100.000 is
a valid value for the load percentage.

Saving setups
After you specify your test settings, you can save the setup (configuration) to use it again for future
tests.

To save a setup (configuration)


1 On the menu bar of the Main screen, select
Test > Save Test Config As...
The Save Test Configuration screen appears, listing existing saved setup files.
2 Select the arrow icon to the right of the Look in: field, and then highlight the directory where
you want to save the configuration.
3 Select the Save Config soft key.
The File Name dialog box appears.
4 Select the keypad icon directly to the right of the Enter a name for the test: field.
A keyboard appears on the screen.
5 Use the keyboard to type a name for the saved setup file. You do not need to enter the .tst
extension; the module automatically appends the extension to the name.
6 If you want to secure the setup so other technicians can not modify it (or delete it using the
Delete All button), select Save as read-only.
7 Select OK to save the setup.
8 To return to the Main screen, select the Exit soft key.
The setup is saved and the file appears on the screen with the other saved setups.

If you setup multiple tests, the settings are saved in a dual configuration file. For more information,
see “Running multiple tests” on page 95.

Understanding write-protected configurations


If you indicate that you want to save a configuration (setup) as read-only, the following occurs:

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 87
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Step 3: Connecting the instrument to the circuit

– Any custom result categories defined for the configuration are also protected.
– The configuration can not be deleted using the Delete All button.
– The configuration can be deleted using the Delete button.
– When you import a read-only configuration file onto your instrument, the instrument will retain
the read-only permissions. Any custom categories defined for the configuration will also be
imported.

Step 3: Connecting the instrument to the circuit


For detailed instructions on connecting your instrument to the circuit, refer to the appropriate testing
manual for the circuit you are testing.

When connecting the unit to optical circuits, bear in mind that applied power must not exceed the
power level specified on the panel for each optical connector.

Step 4: Starting the test


After you configure a test, connect the unit to the circuit, and, if appropriate, turn the laser ON, the
following occurs:

– If you are running a PDH, or classic SONET or SDH application, you must turn the laser ON (if
you are testing an optical circuit). The test starts automatically, and test results immediately
accumulate.
– If you are running an Ethernet, OTN, Fibre Channel, or NextGen application (launched from the
SONET or SDH test menu options), you must turn the laser ON (if you are testing an optical
circuit), and then actively Start Traffic (using the action button).
– If you are running an Ethernet or Fibre Channel application, and you would like your unit to
transmit traffic automatically, you can enable the automatic traffic generation feature. For
details, refer to the Ethernet, IP, TCP/UDP, Fibre Channel, and IP Video Testing Manual that
shipped with your instrument or upgrade.

NOTE: Temperature stabilized lasers


When testing 10 Gigabit, 40 Gigabit or 100 Gigabit optical circuits, some lasers (particularly
1550 nm lasers) are temperature stabilized; therefore, they need to reach a certain temperature
before you can use them to transmit a signal. This is expected behavior, and does not indicate
that there is something wrong with the laser or test instrument.
It typically takes up to one minute for the temperature to stabilize. If you have turned the laser on,
but no signal is present on the receiving instrument or device, simply wait for one minute.

Using the Action buttons


After you start a test, use the buttons at the bottom of the screen to perform actions such as turning
the laser on and off, starting and stopping traffic, starting and stopping a local loopback, and
inserting errors, anomalies, alarms, or defects.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
88 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Step 5: Viewing test results

Table 9 lists some common Action buttons.

Table 9 Action buttons


Button Action

Laser On/Offa Turns the laser on or off when testing optical rates.

Insert Error/Anomaly Inserts an error or anomaly into the transmitted traffic.

Insert Alarm/Defect Inserts an alarm or defect into the transmitted traffic.

Start Traffic/Stop Traffic Starts or stops transmission of Ethernet, IP, Fibre


Channel, OTN, TCP/UDP, or GFP traffic over the cir-
cuit.

a. You can optionally configure optical standard Ethernet and Fibre Channel applications to auto-
matically transmit traffic after you turn the laser ON.

Restarting a test

To restart a test
– Press the Restart soft key.
The unit clears your test results, and then the test restarts.

Stopping a test
When you stop a test, test results immediately stop accumulating, but remain on the display until
you start the test again.

To stop a test
– Press the START/STOP button.
The test stops. To start the test again, you must press the START/STOP button.

NOTE:
If you scheduled a timed test, the test stops automatically after running for the duration you
specified.

Step 5: Viewing test results


Test results appear in the Results Windows of the Main screen.

Setting the result group and category

To set the result group and category


1 Using the Test menu, select a test application see “Step 1: Selecting a test application” on
page 84), and then configure your test (see “Step 2: Configuring a test” on page 86).
2 Select the Results soft key to return to the Main screen.
3 Connect your module to the circuit. For details, refer to the testing manual for the circuit you
are connecting to.
4 If you are testing an optical interface, select the Laser button.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 89
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Step 5: Viewing test results

5 If you selected an Ethernet, Fibre Channel, or SONET/SDH GFP test application, select the
Start Traffic button to start generating and analyzing traffic.
Results appear in the Results Windows.
6 Optional. Insert errors or anomalies into the traffic stream, or use the Action buttons to
perform other actions. These buttons only appear if applicable to your test application.
7 Use the Group and Category buttons to specify the type of results you want to observe.
Figure 55 illustrates buttons for a standard SONET application.

Figure 55 Result Group and Category buttons

Results for the category you selected appear in the result window.
8 Optional. To observe results for a different group or category in another result window, press
the buttons at the top of the window to specify the group and category.
For descriptions of each result, refer to the testing manual for the technology you are testing.

TIP:
If you want to provide a screen shot of key test results, on the Main screen, select
Tools > Capture Screenshot. A screen shot will be captured and stored as a JPG file in the /
acterna/user/disk/bert/images folder. You can include the screen shot when you create
reports.

Expanding and collapsing result measurements


Certain test results for which a variety of measurements are made (such as current, average,
minimum, or peak throughput measurements) can now be expanded (to see all measurements for
the test result), or collapsed (to hide measurements for the test result). When multiple measure-
ments exist for a result, a plus or minus sign appears to the right of the result name.

Collapsing the results that you are not interested in reduces scrolling, and allows you to observe
more results that you are interested in simultaneously.

To expand result measurements


– Select the plus sign to the right of the result name, or
– Select the plus sign at the bottom or the result window to expand all expandable results.

To collapse result measurements


– Select the minus sign to the right of the result name, or
– Select the minus sign at the bottom or the result window to collapse all collapsible results.

Changing the result layout


You can change the default layout of the test results on the Main screen. In many instances, it is
helpful to use the Full Size layout.

To change the default result layout


1 Select View > Result Windows.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
90 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Step 5: Viewing test results

A menu listing the available layouts appears.

2 Select a new layout.


The Result Windows appear using the layout you selected.

Using the entire screen for results


You can expand a single result pane to use the entire screen by selecting the Full Screen button at
the bottom of the pane.

To use the entire screen


1 Use the Group and Category buttons to specify the type of results you want to observe.
2 Select the Full Screen button provided at the bottom of the results pane.
The pane expands to use the entire screen, and the result layout options provided by selecting
View > Result Windows are disabled.

To restore the screen to its original layout, select . After returning the screen to its original
layout, the layouts available from the View menu will be enabled.

Setting the blink option on errors


To alert the user to an error condition, the tab at the top of the screen, indicating the current appli-
cation, can be configured to blink when there is an error condition.The Summary results background
can also be configured to blink if a more obvious indicator is desired.

Configuring the blink option


1 Select Tools > Customize from the menu bar.The Customize User Look and Feel window
appears.

2 Select the check boxes for Blink on Error to have the tab blink and Blink Summary Results
to have the Summary background blink. Blink on Error must be checked to activate the Blink
Summary results option.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 91
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Step 5: Viewing test results

3 Select Close.
The blink on error option is activated.

About histogram results


A histogram is a display or print output of test results in a bar graph format. Histograms enable you
to quickly identify spikes and patterns of errors or anomalies over a specific interval of time
(seconds, minutes, or hours).

Viewing a histogram

To view a histogram
1 Set one of your result groups to Summary, and then select the Histogram category.
The Histogram display appears.

Figure 56 Histogram display (full size)

2 You can modify the default display as follows:


– To view the complete histogram, select Full Size view (see “Changing the result layout” on
page 90).
– To scroll horizontally through the display, use the arrow keys at the top of the pane.
– To change the histogram interval, select the arrow keys to the right of the interval button
(illustrated as “Sec” in Figure 56), and then select the new interval (Min, Hour, or Day).
NOTE:
Histograms are not available when running IP Video applications; however, an event log is
available.

About the Event log


An event log is a display listing any errors, anomalies, alarms, or defects that occur during the
course of your test. The log displays the value for each event, and provides the date and time that
the event occurred.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
92 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Step 5: Viewing test results

Viewing an event log

To view an event log


1 Select the Summary group, and then select the Event Log category.
The associated Event Log appears.

Figure 57 Event Log display (SONET application)

2 To scroll through the display, use the arrow keys at the top of the pane.
The event log is displayed.

About result graphs


You can observe a some results graphically, such as frame loss, packet jitter, throughput, or errors.
Each graph provides a legend underneath the results to help you interpret the graph, and controls
above the results that allow you to customize the scale and indicate whether you want to observe
the mean, minimum, or maximum value for the results.

Viewing graphs

To view a graph
1 Select the Graph group, and then select the category for the results you want to observe.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 93
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Step 5: Viewing test results

The associated Graph appears.

Figure 58 Graph display (Ethernet application)

2 To scroll through the display, use the arrow keys at the top of the pane.
The graph is displayed. You can optionally save the data by selecting the Save Plot Data icon at the
top of the graph.

Clearing History results

To clear history results


– Select Tools > Clear History.
Historical LED results are cleared.

Creating and maintaining Custom result groups


For each available test application on your unit, you can create Custom result groups with results
from a variety of categories. This allows you to quickly view certain results on a single result pane
without navigating through each individual category. You can add up to 50 results to each Custom
group.

To create or maintain custom result groups


1 Set one of your result groups to Custom. If this is the first time you are creating a group, the
Custom result pane is empty.
2 Do one of the following:
– To add a new group, select New ....
– To update an existing group, select the check box to the left of the group name, then select
the wrench icon.
The Configure Custom Results Category screen appears. Summary results appear in the pane
on the left of the screen, and buttons appear at the top of the pane which allow you to display
and then select results from any category for your application.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
94 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Running multiple tests

3 Do one of the following:


– To add results, use the buttons at the top of the left pane to specify the group and category
for the results you want to add, then highlight the result you want to add to the category.
Select the right arrow key to move the result to the Selected Results pane.
– To remove results, select the result you don’t want on the Selected Results pane, then
select the left arrow key to move the result back to the left pane. If you want to delete all of
the results in the category, select Clear.
4 Repeat step 2 and step 3 for each custom group that you want to add or maintain.
5 After you finish populating the custom category with results (or modifying the results), press
Save to store the category and return to the Main screen.
The Custom result group is populated.

You can use the Delete button on the result pane (on the Main screen) to delete a group at any time.

NOTE: Protecting Custom Result Groups


When you protect a saved test configuration by making it read-only, the associated custom
result group is also saved and is protected.

Running multiple tests


You can significantly reduce your testing time by terminating traffic over multiple circuits simultane-
ously.

For example, you can transmit traffic from the DS1 and DS3 PIMs to a network element, and then
loop the traffic back to your unit to analyze the signals and verify that the network element is oper-
ating properly.

When running multiple tests, you should power your instrument using the AC adapter that shipped
with the instrument. If the instrument loses power while running multiple tests, when you restore
power, the instrument will only restore the last active test application.

Restrictions
Certain applications require more system resources; therefore, your instrument may not be able to
run more than one application simultaneously, or you may need to consider the temperature before
running the tests. Table 10 lists the applications that are limited to a single test, or should be run at
lower temperatures.

Table 10 Multiple Test Restrictions


Assembly Application Restriction

MSAM in 6000A Ethernet Applications Two SFP PIMs are required when running applications in Dual Term or
Base Unit in Dual Term or Dual Dual Through mode; therefore, you can only run one application at a
Through Mode time (using both PIMs).

VoIP Additional tests can not be run when running a VoIP test.

IP Video Additional tests can not be run when running an IP Video test.

L3 Triple Play Additional tests can not be run when running a layer 3 Triple Play test.

PRI ISDN Additional tests can not be run when running a PRI ISDN test.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 95
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Running multiple tests

Table 10 Multiple Test Restrictions (Continued)


Assembly Application Restriction

TCP Wirespeed Additional tests can not be run when running a TCP Wirespeed test.

J-Profiler Additional tests can not be run when running a J-Profiler test.

OTN Additional tests can not be run when running an OTN test.

Data communications The HS Datacom and Diphase PIMs require both PIM ports on the
or Diphase MSAM chassis; therefore, you can only run one application at a time
(using a single PIM).

Any other application When running any application at a line rate less than 10 Gbps, you can
at a line rate less than run one additional test at a line rate less than 10 Gbps while operating
10 Gbps the instrument at:
– 32°F to 104°F (0°C to +40°C)

10 Gbps When running a 10 GigE Ethernet, 10 Gig Fibre Channel, OC-192, or


applications STM-64 test, you can run one additional test (at a lower line rate) while
operating the instrument at:
– 32°F to 95°F (0°C to +35°C)
Your battery will not charge while running multiple tests with one appli-
cation at a 10 Gbps line rate. For details, see the section on charging
your battery in the Getting Started Manual that shipped with your instru-
ment or upgrade.

10 Gbps Packet Cap- When running a 10 GigE LAN or WAN application, and capturing data
ture on Port #1, you can not run a 1 GigE application from Port #2. If you
want to run a 1 GigE application on Port #2, you must first disable
packet capture for the 10 GigE application running on Port #1.
You can run applications for lower line rates (for example, 10/100/
10000 Mbps Ethernet) on Port #2 when capturing packets on Port #1
for a 10 GigE application.

NextGen applications Additional tests can not be run when running a NextGen application,
(launched from the and you must use the PIM in port 1. You can not run a second test on
standard SONET or port 2, and you can not run NextGen tests from port 2.
SDH test menu)

MSAMs in 8000 Dual All Please contact your local sales office or technical assistance represen-
Module Carrier tative for a list of restrictions when running multiple tests using this
(DMC) assembly.

Transport Module Ethernet: Multiple Two Multiple Streams applications can be run simultaneously.
with 8000 Base Unit Streams
(10G or less applica-
tions) Jitter Only one optical Jitter test can be run at a time; other applications can
be run simultaneously with the Jitter test.

Wander Additional tests should not be run when running a Wander test.

IP Video Additional tests can not be run when running an IP Video test.

40/100G Transport All 40/100G Transport Module is limited to running a single application.
Module with 8000E
Base Unit

Running multiple tests

To run multiple tests


1 Verify that your instrument is powered using the adapter that shipped with it.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
96 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Running multiple tests

2 Start the first test by doing the following:


a Using the Test menu, select a test application see “Step 1: Selecting a test application”
on page 84).
b Configure the test (see “Step 2: Configuring a test” on page 86).
c Connect the module to the circuit (refer to your instrument’s Getting Started Manual).
d Start the test (see “Step 4: Starting the test” on page 88).
3 To run a second test, do the following:
a Select Test > Add Test.
A a menu appears listing the rates still available for testing. These rates will vary
depending on the rates you are already testing, and on the remaining resources available
on your unit.
For example, if you are currently running a DS1 test using a DS1 PIM on port 1, the DS1
rate is disabled for port 1 because the port is already used. If you are running an OTN test
from port 1, you can not add a second test, even if a PIM is connected to port 2 because
the MSAM needs the resources for the OTN test application.
b Select an application, and then configure the test, connect to the circuit, and start the
test.
You are running multiple tests.

Two tabs appear on the menu bar of the Main screen (as shown in Figure 59), one for each test.

Figure 59 Multiple test tabs, MSAM

A tab also indicates which slot (or application module) and port the currently selected test is running
on. The large tab indicates the currently selected test. Click the other tab to view the results for the
second test.

A green tab indicates no errors, anomalies, alarms, or defects have been detected for a test.

A red tab indicates errors, anomalies, alarms, or defects have been detected for a test.

A yellow tab indicates you should research the conditions displayed in the Summary result category.
In some instances, the conditions constitute errors; in other instances, they are expected and
should not be interpreted as errors. For details, refer to the supporting testing manual.

A blue tab indicates some action is required on your part before the test can proceed. Typically a
dialog box will indicate the type of action required.

The LEDs, results, and tabs applicable to the currently selected test appear on the Main screen.
Each of the other tests is still actively running in the background.

A blue arrow under the tabs indicate that the currently selected test is running:

Figure 60 Test Elapsed Time

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 97
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Running multiple tests

Viewing both tests


When running multiple tests, you can view results side-by-side using the Dual Test View button.

Figure 61 Dual Test View button

The Dual Test View button appears when one of the following occurs:

– a second test is launched.


– you select Enable Dual Test from the View menu.

To view both tests


– Press the Dual Test View button.
The tests are displayed side-by-side.
If Dual Test View is launched with only one test active, the display will look similar to Figure 62.

Figure 62 Dual Test view with one active test

Use the Add Test button to launch a second test as described in “Running multiple tests” on
page 95.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
98 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Running multiple tests

If a second test is active when viewing both tests, the display will look similar to Figure 63.

Figure 63 Dual Test view with two active tests


The buttons included in each side represent the buttons available for that test. For example,
pressing the Restart (at the top) on the left side restarts the 100M Optical Eth Layer 3 Traffic Term
test; similarly, pressing the Config button on the right will display the configurable parameters bar
related to the 10GigE LAN Layer 3 Traffic Term test (see Figure 64), allowing changes to parame-
ters such as “Destination IP” or “Packet Size”. Every tab, when expanded, changes color and the
text changes to “Hide”. Pressing the Hide tab will remove the expanded bar. Only one tab can be
expanded at a time from either side.

Figure 64 Right Window Config Tab expanded

If you want to simultaneously restart both tests, use the Restart Both Tests button in the upper
right.

Use the Test menu to save the dual test configurations or to load a previously saved dual test
configuration.

Use the Reports menu to save (create) a dual test report or to view a previous report.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 99
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Scheduling timed tests

Scheduling timed tests


When you setup a test, you can indicate that the test should run for a specific period of time (Timed
Tests), or you can schedule tests to begin at a specific time (Delayed-start Timed Test).

To schedule a timed test


1 Using the Test menu, select a test application (see “Step 1: Selecting a test application” on
page 84).
2 Select the Setup soft key.
A setup screen with a series of tabs appears.
3 Select the Timed Test tab, and then select one of the following test types:
– Timed Test. If you want the test to start immediately and run for a specific interval of time,
select Timed Test, and then specify the duration for the test in the corresponding fields.
– Delayed-start Timed Test. If you want the test to start at a specific time, and then run for a
specific interval of time, select Delayed-start Timed Test, specify the duration for the test,
and then specify the date and time you want the test to begin in the corresponding fields.
4 In Timed Test Enable, select ON.
5 Specify the timed test duration in the fields provided. Use the up and down arrows to increase
or decrease the intervals, or select a field, and then select the keypad icon to type in a value.
The test duration is specified. The test will run for the interval you specified when you press START
or Restart to begin your test.

NOTE: J-Connect
Do not run timed tests when using J-Connect to detect other JDSU test instruments on a subnet.
For details, see the Ethernet, IP, TCP/UDP, Fibre Channel, and IP Video Testing Manual that
shipped with your instrument or upgrade.

Creating and printing reports


Use the Reports option on the Menu bar or the PRINT/EXPORT key on the front panel of your unit
to format, create, store, and print reports detailing the current setup and test results. You can also
optionally include screen shots in your reports.

NOTE:
Depending on the version of T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit you have, the key may be labeled
PRINT or may be labeled EXPORT (on UIMv2).

Including a logo in your reports

If you want to include a logo in your report, do the following:


1 Load the logo graphic in a .png, .jpg, or .jpeg format into the following folder on your unit:
/acterna/user/disk/bert/images

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
100 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Creating and printing reports

NOTE:
The file must be no larger than 1900 x 1200 resolution. If importing a file larger than this, the
graphic may not appear on the report.

For details concerning loading files onto your unit, refer to the 6000A Base Unit User Manual.
2 Select Reports > Edit User Info, and then press Select logo ... to navigate to the cflash/
bert/images folder, select the logo graphic, and then press Select.
The logo is selected, and you return to the Edit User Info screen.

NOTE:
Some automated test applications allow you to save the report details as a profile. This includes
the directory path for the logo. However, if you move the profile from one unit to another, you
must ensure that the logo file is in the same directory on the unit that you are using.

Specifying report details


Before creating a report, you can specify details that will be captured in the report header, such as
the name, model, software revision, serial number of the device under test, or the name of the tech-
nician running the test. You can also import your company logo to include it in the report.

To specify details about the report


1 From the menu bar, select Reports > Edit User Info.
The Edit User Info screen appears.
2 To specify information about the device you are currently testing, select the Device Under
Test tab (if it isn’t already displayed), and then use the keypads provided to type the following:
– Owner (represents the owner of the device).
– Device Under Test (represents the name or model of the device).
– Software Revision (represents the software revision the device is currently running).
– Serial Number.
– Comment.
3 If you want to specify additional comments concerning test results or the tester, select the
Tester Comments tab, and use the keypads provided to type additional information.
4 If you want to change the default name for your Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and
MSAM as provided in the report, select the Test Instrument tab, and then type the revised
model name.
5 Select Ok to store the report details and return to the Main Screen.
Report details are specified.

Creating a report
You can create reports in a PDF, CSV, Text, HTML, or XML format. Before creating a report, you
can choose the type of content provided in the report. For example, you can include the details you
specified as the User Info, select specific configuration groups (corresponding to the information
that you specified on the setup tabs), and select key result groups that you want to review in detail.

You can also indicate whether you want to include captured screen shots in the report.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 101
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Creating and printing reports

To create a report
1 On the Main screen, select Reports > Create Report ...
The Create Report dialog box appears.
2 Your unit will automatically assign a default file name to your report as follows:
– The port number (if applicable) appears at the beginning of the name. For example, if you
are creating a report while running a test on Port 1, “P1_” appears at the beginning of the
name.
– The interface appears next. For example, if you are currently running a test on a
1 Gigabit Ethernet circuit, “1GigE” appears after “P1_.
– The date and time, expressed per ISO 8601, appear after the interface.
– Finally, a “report” suffix ends the filename.
– The appropriate extension for the file format that you specify will be assigned when the
report is created. For example, if you select the Text format, a “txt” extension will automat-
ically be assigned to the file name.
If you do not want to use the default filename, launch the keypad for the File Name field, and
then type a name using up to 60 characters.
3 In Format, select PDF, CSV, Text, HTML, or XML.
4 Select Choose Contents, and then expand each of the following report information groups
by selecting the plus sign to the left.
– User Info
– Configuration Groups
– Results Groups
– Event Loggers
– Histograms
– Screenshots
Review each of the reportable elements, and then select the elements you want to report, or
clear those you do not want to include in the report output.
If you want to unselect all Report Groups or Screenshots, use the Unselect All or Unselect
Screenshots button.
If you want to select all Report Groups or Screenshots, use the Select All or Select Screen-
shots button.
5 If you want to view the report after it is created, select the checkbox to the left of View report
after creation.
6 Select Create Report.
A watch icon appears indicating that you should wait for the report to be created. If you selected
View report after creation, the report appears automatically; otherwise, it is stored in the following
folder and can be viewed at any time:

acterna/user/disk/bert/reports

Printing reports
If using a T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit, you can print reports. If using a T-BERD ⁄ MTS 6000A
base unit, use the Export Report to USB command and transfer the file to a PC for printing.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
102 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Creating and printing reports

Before printing a report, verify that you specified a printer when you set up your unit. If you need to
specify a printer, refer to the Base Unit User Manual that shipped with your instrument.

To print a report
1 From the menu bar, select Reports > View Report.
The View Reports dialog box appears.
2 Select the report that you want to print, then press View.
3 Press the PRINT/EXPORT key on the front panel of your unit.
4 Specify the print rate (the entire report, or the current page).
The unit sends the report to the printer.

Generating reports automatically


You can set up your instrument to automatically generate reports at specific intervals. When you set
up automatic reports, you can specify a suffix to append to each report, indicate the file format for
the reports, and select the content for automatically generated reports.

To setup your module to generate reports automatically


1 From the menu bar, select Reports > Automatic Reports.
The Automatic Report Settings screen appears.
2 Select the Enable automatic reports check box.
3 Using the keypads and arrows provided, specify the reporting period in hours and minutes.
4 In Mode, specify whether you’d like the module to overwrite the previous automatic report
each time it generates an automatic report, or create a new, separate report file.
5 By default, “AutoReport” is appended to the end of the filename of each automatically gener-
ated report. If you’d like to use a different suffix, in Report Name, type a new suffix.
6 In Report Format, select PDF, CSV, Text, HTML, or XML.
7 Select Choose Contents, and then expand each of the following report information groups
by selecting the plus sign to the left.
– User Info
– Configuration Groups
– Results Groups
– Event Loggers
– Histograms
– Screenshots
Review each of the reportable elements, and then select the elements you want to report, or
clear those you do not want to include in the report output.
8 Select OK to store the automatic report settings and return to the Main Screen.
Reports will be automatically generated at the intervals you specified as the reporting period. When
the module generates an automatic report, a dialog box will briefly appear indicating that a report is
being generated.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 103
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Creating and printing reports

Viewing a report

To view a report
1 On the Menu bar, select Reports > View.
The Reports screen appears, listing the contents of:
acterna/user/harddisk/bert/reports
2 To display the report on the user interface of your module, select the report file from the list,
and then select View Report.
The report viewer appears, providing:
– Arrows that allow you to navigate through the contents of the report.
– A binoculars (lookup) button that allows you to search for key terms in the report.
– A rotate button that rotates the display of your report, and changes the default report orien-
tation from landscape to portrait.
– A folder button that allows you to rename the report and store it in a different folder.
– An X button that closes the report viewer and returns you to the Reports screen.
3 To print the report you are viewing, press the PRINT/EXPORT key (located on the front of
your T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000 base unit).
The instrument sends the report to the printer.

Accessing test reports remotely


Using FTP, you can view, print, or save the test reports on your unit from a remote workstation.

NOTE:
– Verify that your system’s Security Mode is set to Standard. You cannot access the test reports
remotely if the mode is set to Enhanced.
– When using your unit remotely, it is helpful to lock the screen to prevent other users from
disrupting your testing.
For details on locking the screen or specifying the system’s security mode, refer to the base unit
manual for your instrument.

To access test reports using FTP


1 Launch your web browser, and then go to the following address:
ftp://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/disk/
where xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx represents the static or DHCP assigned IP address of the Base
unit.
A log on screen appears.
2 Do the following:
a In User name, do one of the following:
– If you are using an MSAM, enter t-berd6000 or mts6000 using lower case characters.
– If you are using a Transport Module, enter t-berd8000 or mts8000 using lower case charac-
ters.
b In Password, enter acterna using lower case characters.
c Select Log On.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
104 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
Restoring test defaults

The bert directory (folder) appears in your browser window.


3 Open the bert directory, and then open the reports directory.
The reports that are stored on your unit appear.
4 Select, and then save the report to a directory on your workstation, or simply open the report
and view it remotely.

Exporting reports
After generating a report, you can export the report file to a USB memory key. Two USB slots are
provided on the top panel of your base unit.

To export a report to a USB memory key


1 Insert a USB memory key into one of the two slots provided on the top panel of the base unit.
2 On the Menu Bar, select Reports > Export Report to USB.
The Reports screen appears, listing the contents of:
acterna/user/disk/bert/reports
3 Select the report you want to export, and then select the Export button.
The File Export dialog box appears, indicating that the unit is copying the selected report file to
the USB memory key.
The report is exported.

Before removing the USB key, you must eject the USB.
View the File Manager (using the File key), and then select the Eject USB soft key. After the Eject
USB soft key disappears, it is safe to remove the USB.

Restoring test defaults


You can restore test settings to the factory defaults at any time.

To restore test defaults


– On the Main screen, select Tools > Reset Test to Defaults.
The default settings are restored.

VT-100 emulation
If your instrument is optioned to do so, you can use it to emulate a VT-100 terminal, and then
connect it to a network element (such as an HTU-R, HTU-C, HRE, or SmartJack (NIU)) via a serial
interface to gather information about the element. When emulating a VT-100 terminal, data from the
network element appears on the Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM screen. You
can save this information to an ASCII file, print it, or export it. Information gathered typically includes
loss, margin, synchronization, performance (SES, ES, UAS, etc.), and alarm information.

During a VT100 session, you can also configure and provision the accessed network element from
the Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM. When using VT-100 emulation, you must
connect the optional USB keyboard to the instrument to issue queries and commands.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 105
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
VT-100 emulation

Establishing a serial connection


When you order the VT-100 Emulation option, JDSU ships a USB to serial (DB-9) cable with the
instrument or option. This cable has been tested for use with the Dual Module Carrier,
Transport Module, and MSAM, and should be used whenever you connect the Dual Module Carrier,
Transport Module, and MSAM to a network element for VT-100 communication.

To establish a serial connection for VT-100 emulation


1 Turn the Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM ON.
2 Verify that you have the JDSU supplied cable that shipped with the VT-100 option or with your
test instrument.
3 Connect the USB connector to one of the USB slots on the top panel of your test instrument.
4 Connect the DB-9 serial connector to the network element.
A connection is established.

Running a VT-100 session


After establishing a serial connection to the network element, you can run a VT-100 terminal emula-
tion session to query or configure the element.

To run a VT-100 terminal emulation session


1 If you haven’t already done so, turn the Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM
ON, and establish a connection to the network element (see “Establishing a serial connec-
tion” on page 106).
2 From the Menu Bar, select Tools > VT-100 Emulation.
The VT-100 Terminal screen appears, with softkeys to the right that allow you to do the
following:
– VT-100 Setup. Use this softkey to specify values for the session (as described in step 3 on
page 106.
– Clear Screen. Use this softkey to clear the data currently displayed on the terminal screen.
– Hide Keyboard. Use this softkey to hide the keyboard. This is helpful when using a USB
keyboard, or if you want to observe more data on the terminal screen.
– Move Keyboard. Use this softkey to move the keyboard to the top or bottom of the terminal
screen. This is helpful if the keyboard is blocking the display of key data.
– Autobaud. Use this softkey to send a series of sequential space characters to force the
network element to re-evaluate its baud rate.
– Capture Screen. Use this softkey to capture the data on the terminal screen and save it in
an ASCII file.
– Exit. Use this softkey to end the session and return to the Main screen.
3 To specify the settings required for the session, select VT-100 Setup. The VT-100 Setup
screen appears.
a Under Port Settings, specify values for the following:

Setting Value

Baud Rate Select one of the predefined baud rates ranging from 50 to 115200
Kbps.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
106 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
HTML Viewer

Setting Value

Data Bits Select the number of data bits (ranging from 5 to 8) that contain infor-
mation. These are the bits that are not used to start, stop, or provide
checksum values.

Parity Indicate whether no parity check will be performed (None), or


whether the instrument will use odd or even bits for parity checking.

Stop Bits Indicate whether bit 1 or bit 2 will be used as the stop bit.
Flow Control Indicate whether the instrument will use software (X ON / X OFF
codes), hardware, or no flow control (None).

b Under Terminal Settings, specify values for the following:

Setting Value

Enter/Return Select CR to send a carriage return every time you press Enter, LF
to send a line feed, or CR + LF to send both.
Local Echo If you want to echo the characters you type on the MSAM screen,
select ON; otherwise, select OFF.

Enable Reserved Keys If you want to use the keyboard’s function keys when communicating
with the network element, select Enable; otherwise, select Disable.
NOTE:
If you enable reserved keys, the buttons on your instrument will be
disabled. Be certain to change this setting back to Disable when you
are done with your VT-100 session.

4 Select the Terminal Window softkey to return to the VT-100 Terminal screen, then use the
keyboard to issue commands just as you would on a VT-100 terminal.
You are running a VT-100 session.

Saving terminal screen data


When running a VT-100 session, you can capture the data on the terminal screen. The instrument
saves the data to an ASCII file; you can export the file just as you would any other report on the
instrument (see “Exporting reports” on page 105).

To save terminal screen data


– Select the Capture Screen softkey. The instrument captures the data on the terminal screen
and saves it in an ASCII file in the following location:
/acterna/user/disk/bert/reports
The data on the screen is saved.

HTML Viewer
An HTML viewer is available on the MSAM which allows you to view and navigate through the
MSAM HTML help topics and any reports that you stored in an HTML format. When used to display
help topics, the viewer remembers and returns you to the last help topic you visited for a specific

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 107
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
HTML Viewer

test application while you are actively running the application. You can return to the Contents page
at any time by selecting the Home soft key. If you change test applications, the last help topic is no
longer stored because the viewer will track the topics visited for the new application.

For specifics on using the viewer, see:

– “Launching the viewer” on page 108


– “Navigating using the viewer” on page 108
– “Exiting the viewer” on page 109

Launching the viewer


The viewer is launched automatically whenever you do one of the following:

– Select Help > User Manual to view the topics in the testing manual for your instrument on the
unit itself.
– Select Reports > View Report, and then select an HTML file.

Navigating using the viewer


The viewer provides softkeys that allow you to navigate through a series of HTML pages.

Scrolling
A scroll bar appears on the right of the viewer window; select and then drag it down to move to the
bottom of the page, or drag it up to move to the top of the page.

Finding text on a page


You can search for a specific term on a page using the Find in page feature.

To find a specific term


1 Select the Find in page field. A keypad appears.
2 Type the term you want to search for, and then select OK. The keypad closes, and the term
appears in the field.
3 Select Find. The viewer scrolls to and highlights the first instance of the term on the page.

Selecting links
Links to other help topics or HTML pages appear in blue. To jump to another topic or page from a
link, simply or select tap the link.

Going back or forward one pages


Softkeys are provided that allow you to move Back and Forward through a series of previously
visited pages

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
108 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
HTML Viewer

Going home
The Home softkey takes you to the home page. For example, if you are browsing through the HTML
help topics, pressing Home returns you to the Contents page.

Exiting the viewer


To exit the viewer, use the Results or Setup soft key, or the Results of Setup hard key on the right
of the front panel. You will return to the last Result view (on the Main screen) or the Setup tab that
you visited before launching the HTML viewer.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 109
Chapter 4 Basic Testing
HTML Viewer

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
110 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
5
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting

This chapter describes how to maintain your unit and identify and correct issues related to the T-
BERD / MTS 5800, Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM. Topics discussed in this
chapter include the following:

– “Cleaning the instrument and optical connections” on page 112


– “About troubleshooting” on page 122
– “Assembly and setup” on page 122
– “Operating the instrument” on page 123
– “Performing tests” on page 124
– “Maintaining your instrument” on page 126
– “Battery communication” on page 127

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 111
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Cleaning the instrument and optical connections

Cleaning the instrument and optical connections

Cleaning the instrument


The instrument itself does not require any specialized cleaning. An occasional wipe with a damp
cloth is sufficient.

NOTE:
When cleaning the instrument, JDSU recommends a damp cloth and water only. Cleaning with
chemicals could cause damage to the plastic case, buttons, or removal of markings.

Cleaning optical connections


Poor optical performance is typically due to a dirty optical connection, and can be resolved by
cleaning the connectors on the optical cables and jacks. To ensure optimal optical performance,
follow these instructions when cleaning the connectors.

Step 1: Gather cleaning materials


The following materials are recommended for cleaning optical components:

– An optical connector cleaner, such as the CLETOP Cleaning Tape Cassette, manufactured by
NTT-ME Corporation.
– An optical connector cleaning stick, such as the CLETOP STICK manufactured by NTT-ME
Corporation, or the FI-000S from Fiber Instruments.
– Reagent grade isopropyl alcohol in an alcohol dispenser.
– Lint free laboratory wipes, or pre-saturated wipes, such as Chemtronics CP410 wipes.
– Clean, dry, oil-free compressed air, such as FIS MICRO DUSTER.

NOTE:
JDSU offers the OCK-10 Cleaning kit, which includes a CLETOP cleaning tape cassette, spare
tape for the cassette, lint free laboratory wipes, and cleaning sticks (swabs). To order a kit, con-
tact JDSU Customer Care.

Step 2: Cleaning the cable connectors


If optical performance of your unit is poor, clean the ferrule tip of the optical cable connector using
alcohol and lint free lab wipes or a CLETOP reel type cleaner. To ensure a good connection, clean
the connectors every time you connect the cables to the optical jacks.

To clean the cable connectors


1 Remove the protective cap on the optical fiber cable connector.
2 If you are cleaning the connector using the CLETOP reel type cleaner, proceed to step 3; other-
wise, if you are cleaning the connector using alcohol wipes, do the following:
a If you are using a pre-saturated alcohol wipe, proceed to step b; otherwise, if you are using
a wipe that is not pre-saturated, fold the wipe several times to get a pad of 6 to 8 layers of
material, and then use the alcohol dispenser to dampen (without soaking) a corner of the
pad.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
112 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Cleaning the instrument and optical connections

b Firmly press the tip of the ferrule (see Figure 65) into the damp area of the wipe.

ferrule tip

Figure 65 Cable connector assembly

Pinch the wipe firmly with your fingers, and then twist the ferrule. Repeat this process three
times, using a clean area of the wipe each time. Clean the tip and as much of the outside of
the ferrule as possible.
c To dry the ferrule tip, press it into a clean, dry spot of the wipe, pinch, and then twist one
time.
d Discard the used wipe.
e Optional. Use the compressed air can to remove tissue fragments that may have been
deposited on the tip of connector.
3 If you are cleaning the connector using the CLETOP reel type cleaner, do the following:
a Press the lever on the left of the CLETOP reel up to expose the cleaning tape.
b Place the top of the connector squarely at the top of the exposed cleaning tape.
c Rotate the connector clock-wise, and then counter clock-wise.
d Swipe the connector down to the bottom of the exposed tape.
e Release the lever on the CLETOP reel to cover and protect the cleaning tape.
4 Inspect the ferrule. If it is still dirty, repeat step 2 or step 3.
The cable connector is clean.

Step 3: Clean the optical jack and the front shell


If after cleaning the cable connector, you still suspect performance is not ideal due to a dirty front
shell or optical jack, remove the shell from the jack, and then clean the jack and the front shell thor-
oughly using optical connector cleaning sticks and compressed air.

You can also used laboratory wipes dampened with alcohol to clean the optical jack of the Transport
Module.

NOTE:
If the front shell has been used with clean, defect free fiber connectors and capped when not in
use, it typically does not require cleaning.

WARNING:
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for use of compressed air. Improper use of compressed
air can result in contamination of the front shell.

CAUTION: HAZARDOUS LIGHT EXPOSURE


Turn the Laser OFF on the 5800, Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM before
cleaning the optical jack and the front shell.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 113
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Cleaning the instrument and optical connections

To clean the optical jack and the front shell


1 Verify that the laser is turned OFF on the Transport Module.
2 If the front shell is already connected to the rear shell in the connector panel, do the following:
a Release the locking lever by rotating it upwards (see Figure 66).

Figure 66 Releasing the locking lever

b Remove the front shell as illustrated in Figure 67.

Figure 67 Removing the front shell from the connector panel

3 To clean the inside of the optical jack, swab an optical connector cleaning stick around the
jack, and then gently rotate the stick 4 to 5 times (see Figure 68).

Figure 68 Cleaning the optical jack

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
114 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Installing a front shell into an optical jack

4 To clean the front shell, use one of the following methods:


– If you are using compressed air, point the can away from the shell, and then release a short
blast of compressed air (to remove any dust inside the nozzle of the can). Then, point the
can towards the shell, and release three to four short blasts of air.
– If you are using an optical connector cleaning stick, insert the stick inside the shell, and then
gently rotate the stick 4 to 5 times.
The optical jack and the front shell are clean.To install the front shell in the optical jack, see
“Installing a front shell into an optical jack” on page 115.

Installing a front shell into an optical jack


After you clean the front shell and the optical jack itself (see “Cleaning the instrument and optical
connections” on page 112), you can install the shell into the jack.

To install a shell into an optical jack


1 Verify that the laser is turned OFF on the Transport Module.
2 Verify that the locking lever of the front shell is in a released position (see Figure 69).

Figure 69 Released locking lever

3 Holding the top and bottom of the front shell as illustrated in Figure 70, align the shell
squarely with the four sides of the optical jack on the panel.

Figure 70 Front shell alignment

NOTE:
If you insert the shell at an angle, or hold the shell with your fingers on the lever, you risk damag-
ing the connector.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 115
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Maintaining the battery

4 Insert the shell into the optical jack on the panel, and then lock the shell in place by rotating
the locking lever downwards until you hear a click (see Figure 71).

Figure 71 Locked locking lever

The front shell is installed.

Maintaining the battery


This section discusses troubleshooting and maintenance information related to the T-BERD / MTS
5800’s rechargeable lithium-ion battery. For the Transport Module and Multiple Services Application
Module, refer to the 8000 Base Unit User Manual or 6000A Base Unit User Manual.

Guidelines
To prolong the life span of the battery, follow the guidelines below:

– WARNING: Danger of extreme heat, fire, or explosion if battery is tampered with. Use only
JDSU approved Li-ION battery. Dispose of used batteries according to the manufacturer's
instructions.
– Do not keep the AC adapter connected continuously. Disconnect the charger about once a
week and operate the T-BERD / MTS 5800 using battery power for a period of time (two or
three hours is recommended). If you have another T-BERD / MTS 5800 and battery, rotate the
T-BERD / MTS 5800 and battery so that the battery gets off of the charger and gets used for
some period of time about once a week, or as often as possible.
– When not connected to the unit, store the battery in a cool, dry, and clean environment. Do not
leave the battery in a car or truck, particularly during extremely hot or cold weather.
– Do not place a property label on the T-BERD / MTS 5800 under the battery. The label can inter-
fere with the alignment and seating of the battery. Place labels on the side of the unit.
– Use the AC adapter to power up the instrument the first time you use it or after prolonged
storage (see “Verifying that you have the correct adapter” on page 52).
– If the battery capacity is depleted or if the product has an external battery and it has been
stored for a prolonged period, use the JDSU battery charger to charge the battery. Do not use
an un-approved charger.
– The charger will not charge the battery when it is extremely hot or cold.
– Always carry a fully charged spare battery.
See “Checking the battery” on page 65 for information on checking the battery status.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
116 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Maintaining the battery

Recharging the battery


TheT-BERD / MTS 5800, T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800 will typically run between two and
five hours on a fully charged battery, depending on the type of test. Some applications or modes
require more power than others, so run time will vary based on the mode.

When the battery level is at 25 percent or less, the battery should be recharged.

NOTE:
You can test a circuit and recharge the battery at the same time. If you do not want to interrupt
the current test, you may leave the power on and connect the AC power adapter. You can also
charge the battery while it is removed from the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800.

To charge the battery


1 Connect one end of the AC adapter to the power jack on the right side panel.
2 Connect the other end of the AC adapter to an AC power supply.

WARNING: ELECTRICAL SHOCK


Electrical shock may result in serious injury or death. Be sure the AC Adapter is connected to the
correct voltage mains. Do not use outdoors or in wet locations. Use only the AC Adapter supplied
with the test set.

3 Let the instrument charge for up to 7 hours depending on the battery charge level.
The power button is amber when the battery is charging.
The battery icon in the title bar turns green when the charge is above the “low battery”
threshold.
Charging the battery is complete.

Replacing the battery


This section discusses replacing the battery in a T-BERD / MTS 5800. For the Transport Module
and Multiple Services Application Module, refer to the 8000 Base Unit User Manual or 6000A Base
Unit User Manual.

The battery compartment is located on the back of the unit.

Before replacing the battery, verify that it is a JDSU-supplied replacement battery pack.

To replace the battery pack


1 Turn the power off.

CAUTION: INSTRUMENT DAMAGE


Failure to turn the power off before removing the batteries from the instrument could damage
internal components and/or corrupt the software. Always power down the unit before removing
the battery pack.

2 Turn the instrument over, resting on the face.


3 Using a phillips screw driver, remove the four screws from the battery compartment door.
4 Remove the battery compartment door.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 117
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Calibrating the touchscreen

5 Pull the battery out of the battery compartment and disengage the battery cable's locking
connector from the mating connector on the right side.
6 Engage the locking connector of the new batter with the mating connector on the right side and
then place the new battery into the battery compartment.
7 Replace the battery compartment door.
8 Tighten the four screws until hand tight.
Replacing the battery pack is complete.

Calibrating the touchscreen


This section discusses calibrating the touchscreen on a T-BERD / MTS 5800. For the Transport
Module and Multiple Services Application Module, refer to the 8000 Base Unit User Manual or
6000A Base Unit User Manual.

After some time, the touchscreen may need to be calibrated. For example, maybe you touch the
screen but the arrow appears elsewhere, or it doesn’t recognize the very top or bottom of the
screen.

To calibrate the touchscreen


1 Select the SYSTEM icon.
The System screen appears.
2 Select Display.
3 Select Calibrate touchscreen.
4 Tap the screen on the cross-hairs, as prompted.
The calibration closes when finished.

Viewing the System Info


To view the revisions of internal components and to see which options are enabled, use the System
Info menu. This menu also provides the serial numbers of internal components. The Copy System
Info to File button is used to save a file that includes all of the system information for the instrument.

Adding options
The T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800 software allows you to add new options to your unit in
the field by entering a unique number key that will un-lock the new feature. Contact your sales repre-
sentative or call JDSU customer service to order your new feature and obtain the unique key for
your unit. This will be a 24-digit number. To generate this key the JDSU customer service represen-
tative will need the BERT serial number of your unit

The following procedure describes how to add options.

To add options
1 Contact your JDSU representative to obtain the number key that will enable the option you
want to add.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
118 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Upgrading the software

2 Select the SYSTEM icon.


3 Select System Info.
4 Click in the New Option Key field. A keyboard appears.
5 Enter the unique number key that was provided by Customer Service, and then select OK.
6 Select Install to add the option.
When the menu is viewed again, a check mark appears next to the option indicating it is available
for use.

Upgrading the software


If you wish to upgrade the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800’s firmware, instructions are
provided with the upgrade package. The instructions include requirements, restrictions, and the
procedure for upgrading the firmware. Please contact your local sales office or technical assistance
representative if you experience significant problems with the upgrade.

For the T-BERD / MTS 5800, follow the procedure below.

The T-BERD / MTS 5800 software can be upgraded in the field two ways:

– Using a USB memory stick. Software can be downloaded from http://5800.update-


myunit.net
– Over a network.
The process for updating varies depending on the way the update is performed.

Downloading from updatemyunit.net


For this download, you need a USB memory stick with at least 750MB of space.

To download software
1 Using a browser, go to
http://5800.updatemyunit.net/
This will bring you to a landing page where you can download the latest self extracting soft-
ware upgrade file.
2 Click the link bert-rpm-x.x.exe for the desired version of software.
3 Save the file to your desktop.
The software is downloaded.

Extracting the software to a USB stick


After downloading the software, you can put it on a USB stick.

To extract the files to a USB stick


1 Plug the USB memory stick into your PC.
2 Double-click the downloaded self-extracting file you saved to your desktop. Click Run in the
resulting dialog box.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 119
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Upgrading the software

A dialog box appears asking for the location to extract the files.

3 Click Browse to navigate to the USB stick, and then click Set.
4 Click Extract.
The files are extracted to the USB stick.
After files are extracted, do not remove the USB stick.
5 Navigate to the USB stick using Windows Explorer, right-click on the USB, and then select
Eject.
6 Remove the USB stick from the PC.
The software is ready to be installed on the instrument.

Updating using a USB stick

To update using a USB stick


1 Connect the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 to the AC charger adapter to ensure an uninterrupted supply
of power during the update.

WARNING: ELECTRICAL SHOCK


Electrical shock may result in serious injury or death. Be sure the AC adapter is connected to
the correct voltage mains. Do not use outdoors or in wet locations. Use only the AC adapter
supplied with the tester.

2 Connect the USB flash drive that contains the software into the USB connector on the top
panel.
3 Select the SYSTEM icon.
4 Select Upgrade.
5 Select USB.
The version information is displayed.
If the release is equal to the current software level an equals symbol will be displayed next to
the upgrade version number.
If the release is a retrograde (earlier software version) a down arrow will be displayed next to
the upgrade version number.
If the release is an upgrade (later software version) an up arrow will be displayed next to the
upgrade version number.
6 Select Start Upgrade.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
120 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Upgrading the software

A dialog box appears directing you to exit any existing tests. You have the option to cancel the
upgrade at this point (perhaps you are currently running a test, so you wish to postpone the
upgrade).
7 Select OK.
The software is installed and the unit reboots when done. After the reboot, remove the USB stick
from the instrument.

Updating over a network

To update over a network


1 Connect the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 to the AC charger adapter to ensure an uninterrupted supply
of power during the update.

WARNING: ELECTRICAL SHOCK


Electrical shock may result in serious injury or death. Be sure the AC adapter is connected to the
correct voltage mains. Do not use outdoors or in wet locations. Use only the AC adapter supplied
with the tester.

2 Select the SYSTEM icon.


3 Select Upgrade.
4 Select Network.
NOTE:
A wired network connection is recommended for software upgrades.

5 Do one of the following:


– Enter the address where the software file is located. This could include FTP address, server
IP address or hostname, and the proxy server address if necessary, as well as the User
Name and Password.
– Enter the server address:
http://5800.updatemyunit.net/
TIP:
You may experience problems accessing the update myunit.net site from behind a firewall.
If this is the case, please connect the unit or your PC to a public network to perform the upgrade.

6 Select Connect.
The version information is displayed.
If the release is equal to the current software level an equals symbol will be displayed next to
the upgrade version number.
If the release is a retrograde (earlier software version) a down arrow will be displayed next to
the upgrade version number.
If the release is an upgrade (later software version) an up arrow will be displayed next to the
upgrade version number.
7 Select Start Upgrade.
A dialog box appears directing you to exit any existing tests. You have the option to cancel the
upgrade at this point (perhaps you are currently running a test, so you wish to postpone the
upgrade).
8 Select OK.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 121
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
About troubleshooting

The unit will communicate with the upgrade server, download the software and install it.
NOTE:
You will be downloading a file in excess of 700MB via this method. The update will typically take
15 to 30 minutes, depending on the speed and reliability of the network.

Retrograding the software


If you require an earlier software version (you wish to retrograde your unit's software), use the link
“Older software releases are available here” at the bottom of the
updatemyunit.net page. Older released versions of software for the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 58000 are
available as self-extracting files.

The software must be updated using the USB method (cannot be done over the network). Down-
load it to your PC and then extract to a USB stick.

NOTE: MAY LOSE FUNCTIONALITY


Please be aware that retrograding your unit to older software releases may render some installed
software options unusable - especially if these software test options were released after the date
of the software release you retrograde to. Please proceed with caution. Once complete, if some
of your previously installed test options disappear, these can be restored by upgrading to the
most recent software version again.

About troubleshooting
If you experience problems using your instrument, you may be able to solve these problems on your
own after referring to this section. If you experience significant problems with the module, call the
Technical Assistance Center (see “Technical assistance” on page xxii).

Assembly and setup


The following issues may arise when assembling and setting up the instrument.

Which transceivers are compatible with the instrument?


A list of JDSU recommended optics is available by selecting the corresponding option from the Help
menu on the user interface of your instrument. You can also see detailed information for the
currently inserted SFP, XFP, QSFP+ or CFP on the Interface setup tab of the user interface.

Can I hot-swap MSAMs?


No, MSAMs are not hot-swappable. You must power down the instrument and unplug the power
adapter before swapping MSAMs.

Can I hot-swap PIMs?


No, PIMs are not hot-swappable. You must turn the BERT module OFF before inserting or swapping
PIMs.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
122 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Operating the instrument

Can I hot-swap transceivers?


Yes, all transceivers (SFPs, XFPs, QSFP+s and CFPs) are hot-swappable.

Can I do dual port testing from a single SFP PIM?


No. Two SFP jacks are provided on the PIM to allow you to insert transceivers for different line rates
or wavelengths without swapping SFPs. This minimizes wear and tear on the SFPs.

If you need to perform dual port tests, you need a dual port chassis and two SFP PIMs.

No signal is detected when running 10 GigE application


There are several reasons why a signal may not be detected:

– Verify that the XFP transceiver is properly inserted.


– Turn the laser OFF, and then ON again.
– If you are using an MSAM, verify that the MSAM chassis supports 10 GigE testing. If so, the
panel will be labeled C1000 or C1004.
– If you are using an MSAMv1, verify that the XFP PIM is inserted properly in Port 1. It will not
work if it is inserted in Port 2. This restriction does not apply to MSAMv2.

Operating the instrument


The following issues may present themselves when operating and performing basic functions using
your instrument.

How much space is available for my data?

T-BERD / MTS 5800


There is roughly 1 GB of space available for storing data such as reports.

MSAM with 6000A Base Unit


There is roughly 512 MB of space available for storing data such as reports.

Transport Module with 8000 Base Unit


50% of the base unit hard drive is available for storing data such as reports.

MSAMs with DMC and 8000 Base Unit


50% of the base unit hard drive is available for storing data such as reports. If the disk is full, you
will be alerted to the situation when you attempt to save your data.

Instrument will not power up


There are several reasons why the instrument may not be powering:

– Check the power source and restart the instrument.


– If the instrument is running on the power adapter, verify that the power source is adequate.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 123
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Performing tests

– Verify that the components are secured tightly to the base unit. The instrument will not power
up if it is not properly assembled.
– Unplug the power adapter. Remove the battery, and then reconnect the battery. Plug in the
power adapter, and then turn the instrument ON.

Can not print test results


Verify the following:

– Verify that the printer cable is properly connected to the instrument. For instructions on
connecting a printer to the base unit, refer to the base unit manual that shipped with your instru-
ment or upgrade.
– Verify that correct printer is specified for the instrument (see “Specifying a printer for the instru-
ment” on page 71).
– Verify that your printer is working properly.
– Verify that the printer is turned on and loaded with paper.

Instrument shows an unused slot


In rare instances, the instrument may show an unused slot. This is more likely to occur if a MSAM
is swapped while the base unit is using AC power but may occur after upgrading firmware.

If it occurs after upgrading the firmware, hard boot the instrument: power down and unplug the
adapter, then replug the adapter and power up again.

If removing a MSAM, power down the instrument and unplug the AC adapter. See “Inserting
MSAMs or CSAMs into the 6000A base unit or DMC” on page 39.

Instrument does not recognize USB stick


Do the following:

– Reboot the instrument. Verify that your instrument is OFF, and then unplug the unit for at least
5 seconds to force a hard boot.
– Reconnect AC power to the unit.
– Turn ON the unit.
– Re-insert the USB stick. This should resolve the issue.

Performing tests
The following section addresses questions that may be asked about completing tests with the
instrument.

Application does not appear on the Test menu


Verify the following:

– Ensure that the required test option is installed. For example, if you are looking for MiM (PBT)
applications, or if you do not see the settings required to verify layer 2 transparency, verify that
you installed the associated test option.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
124 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Performing tests

– If you are testing using an MSAM, ensure that the appropriate PIM is inserted in the MSAM
chassis. For example, to see DS1 applications, a DS1 PIM must be inserted into a port on the
chassis. If an SFP PIM is inserted, the DS1 applications will not appear.

Optical Overload Protection is activated


When testing on an optical circuit, the instrument displays a warning that the Optical Overload
Protection is activated, or the instrument does not detect a signal.

Verify that the applied power does not exceed the power level supported by the connected trans-
ceiver. If it does, attenuate the signal.

MSAM or Transport Module user interface is not launching


After verifying that the appropriate BERT icon is highlighted in yellow with a green outline, press the
Results or the Start/Stop key to display the MSAM user interface.

The green outline indicates which particular BERT module the instrument is currently displaying the
user interface for (in other words, it is the module in focus). A yellow icon without a green outline
indicates that the BERT module is active, but that the user interface is not displayed.

Test results are inconsistent


Verify the following:

– Verify that your instrument is connected to the circuit properly for the test you are running. For
details, see “Connecting the Transport Module to the circuit” on page 75 or “Connecting the
MSAM to the circuit” on page 78. This is the primary reason for inconsistent test results.
– Verify that your transceivers and cables are good and are connected properly for the test you
are performing.
– Verify that you have inserted the correct transceiver for the circuit you are testing. SFPs and
XFPs are designed to support different line rates and interfaces.
– Verify that the correct timing source is selected on the Interface setup screen.
– Verify that the correct line rate for the interface is selected.
– If you are running SONET or SDH applications, verify that the correct mapping, tributaries, and
analysis rates are selected.
– If an object or person coming in contact with the test set causes a temporary burst of errors to
be recorded, the errors might have been caused by an ESD event. The recorded errors can be
cleared by pressing Test Restart. Please note that the test set is fully compliant with IEC 61326-
1 ESD requirements for industrial equipment and has passed testing according to IEC 61000-
4-2 using test limits of 4 kV/8 kV contact/air and performance criterion B.
The best method of preventing ESD events is to use an ESD wrist strap and/or use a
grounding mat or table. JDSU recognizes that most field users will not have access to these
items at will and therefore cannot have an ideal, ESD-free environment.
In this case JDSU offers the steps below to help reduce the chances of an ESD event as
much as possible.
a Zero Potential - Most importantly, make sure that you and the test set are at Zero Poten-
tial by touching the metal frame of the AC mains power strip before touching the unit
both before and during the test.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 125
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Maintaining your instrument

b Restricting movement – When achieving zero potential through the above means is not
practical, it is recommended to stand upright while using the test set or otherwise mini-
mize movement. Even when still, use of ESD-safe furniture is recommended whenever
possible.
c Clothes - Make sure not to wear any clothing that builds excessive electrical charge,
such as a wool sweater.
d Weather - Electrical storms can increase the risk of ESD events. Unless absolutely
necessary, try not to use the test set during an electrical storm.
e Accessories - To help reduce ESD and help prevent other problems, it is also a good
idea to remove all jewelry.

Result values are blank


Results are blank if gating criteria have not been met. Criteria examples include Signal Present,
Frame Sync Present, Pointer Present, and BERT Pattern Sync Present.

No RFC 2544 or FC test buttons appear


If the RFC 2544 Test or FC Test buttons do not appear on the Main screen, verify the following:

– Payload analysis is ON for your current test application. You can not run the automated RFC
2544 or FC tests when the instrument is configured to analyze live traffic.
– Traffic is not VPLS or MPLS encapsulated. You can not run the RFC 2544 tests with VPLS or
MPLS encapsulated traffic.
– The instrument is not configured to run a multiple streams Ethernet test.
– The instrument is not configured to run a timed test. You can not run the RFC 2544 or FC tests
during a timed test.

Maintaining your instrument


The following section addresses questions that may be asked about maintaining your instrument.

How often does the instrument need to be calibrated?


– TheT-BERD / MTS 5800, MSAM,and CSAM must be calibrated every 36 months.
– The 6000A base unit must be calibrated every 12 months if the VFL and PM options are
installed.
– The Transport Module must be calibrated every 36 months.
– For calibration intervals for the 8000 base unit, refer to the base unit user’s manual.

What are the insertion rates for all components?


– The MSAM and Fiber Optics chassis can be inserted into the 6000A base unit up to 1,000
times.
– The MSAM can be inserted into the DMC chassis up to 1,000 times.
– Each PIM can be inserted into the MSAM chassis up to 1,000 times.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
126 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Battery communication

– Each SFP or XFP transceiver can be inserted into the jacks provided on the PIMs up to 100
times. More insertions may be possible, but after 100 times, the pluggable optic should be
checked.

Battery communication
The following section addresses questions that may be asked about powering the instrument using
the battery.

Battery gauge reading is inaccurate


Some users have experienced sporadic issues with battery communication when using the 8000
Base Unit and Battery Modules. When communication issues occur, the battery gauge reading is
no longer accurate, and warnings will not be presented to warn you that the battery is low.

The 8000 Base Unit detects the problem if it exists. If the power adapter is connected to your unit
when the unit detects the problem, the warning message in Figure 72 appears:

Figure 72 Battery communication warning

A similar message is presented when the power adapter is not connected to the unit.

To restore battery communication, you must turn OFF the instrument, and restart the instrument.

To restore battery communication


1 Do one of the following:
– If a test is currently in progress, and you want to wait to turn OFF the instrument, verify that
power is supplied using the adapter, and then select Ask me again later.
The instrument will continue running the test (if power is supplied using the adapter), and
will prompt you later to restart the instrument.
– If no tests are currently in progress, verify that the power adapter is disconnected, and then
select Restart Now to restart the instrument immediately.
After you turn OFF or restart the unit, battery communication is restored.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 127
Chapter 5 Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Battery communication

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
128 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
A
Appendix A Specifications

This appendix contains specifications for the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800, Dual Module Carrier,
Transport Module, and MSAM. Topics discussed in this appendix include the following:

– “T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications” on page 130


– “MSAM specifications” on page 141
– “Transport Module specifications” on page 174
– “Jitter and Wander specifications” on page 187
– “40G/100G Transport Module specifications” on page 200
– “Battery Specifications” on page 200
– “Transceiver specifications” on page 204
– “Environmental specifications” on page 204

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 129
Appendix A Specifications
T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications

T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications

Physical specifications
The physical characteristics for the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 5800 are listed in Table 11.

Table 11 Physical specifications


Dimension 5801/5801/5812 5801P/5801P/5812P 5811PL/5822P

Height 6.7 inches / 17.02 cm 6.7 inches / 17.02 cm 7 inches / 17.78 cm

Width 8.4 inches / 21.34 cm 8.4 inches / 21.34 cm 9.5 inches / 24.13 cm

Depth 2.75 inches / 7.00 cm 3.5 inches / 8.90 cm 3 inches / 7.62 cm

Weight 3.25 lb / 1.47 kg 3.8 lb / 1.72 kg 4.2 lb / 1.9 kg

Power specifications
Although battery life varies depending on the type of test, Table 12 provides specifications for the
battery life and the specifications for the AC adapter.

Table 12 Power specifications


Parameter Specification

Operating time Between 2 to 5 hours depending on the application

Charging time Approximately 7 hours from empty

Unit power input 12VDC, 60 Watt Max

Power supply input 100 to 240 VAC, 50/60 Hz, auto-sensing

Power supply output 12VDC, 5 AMP Max

Electrical Ethernet specifications


The electrical Ethernet applications use the RJ-45 jacks. The 10/100/1000 Base-T/Tx interfaces
conform to the IEEE 802.3 electrical requirements.

Table 13 lists the electrical specifications for the 10/100/1000 Mb/s interface.

Table 13 10/100/1000 Mb/s interface specifications


Specification Description

Cable CAT5e 100-Ohm STP cable, < 100 meters

Table 14 lists the electrical Ethernet rates supported.

Table 14 Electrical rates


Rate Mbps

10Base-T Ethernet 10

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
130 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications

Table 14 Electrical rates (Continued)


Rate Mbps

100Base-T Ethernet 100

1000Base-T Ethernet 1000

Clock source (Timing) specifications


Table 15 lists internal and external timing specifications.

Table 15 Timing specifications


Clock Source Description

Internal reference accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging

5800 v1 has SMA from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK


5800 v2 has DIN with adapter cables – BITS
to SMA 1.544 Mbps DS1/T1 signal
– SETS
2.048 Mbps E1 signal
– 2MClock
2.048 MHz ±100 ppm G.703 sync clock (square wave)
– 10M Clock
10.000 MHz ±100 ppm square clock

DS1 specifications
Table 16 through Table 19 on page 132 list specifications for the DS1 connectors.

NOTE:
The E1 and DS1 interfaces should not be connected at the same time. Multiple connections can
influence the integrity of the signal under test. After running your test, disconnect from one inter-
face before connecting to the other interface.

Receiver
Table 16 lists specifications for the DS1 receivers.

Table 16 DS1 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One RX1 Bantam Jack, and one TX/RX2 Bantam jack; both jacks can be used as
receivers

Bit rate 1544 kbps ±250 ppm

Line coding AMI, B8ZS

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 131
Appendix A Specifications
T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications

Table 17 lists the input sensitivity specifications for the DS1 receiver.

Table 17 DS1 receiver sensitivity specifications


Termination Type Impedance Input Range

Bridge >1000  +6 to -35.0 dBdsx due to cable loss

Terminate 100  nom +6 to -35.0 dBdsx due to cable loss

DSX monitor 100  nom -20 dBdsx due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to -6 dB
due to cable loss

Transmitter
Table 18 lists specifications for the DS1 transmitter.

Table 18 DS1 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One TX/RX2 Bantam jack; only the TX/RX2 jack can be used as a transmitter

Output 6 Vnom peak-peak into 100 


Complies with ANSI T1.403-1999.

Line build out 0 dB, -7.5 dB, -15.0 dB or -22.5 dB due to cable loss at 772 kHz
(LBO) level

LBO level accuracy At 772 kHz relative to the signal at 0 dBdsx:


– ± 2.5 dB for -7.5 dB
– ±3 dB for -15.0 dB and -22.5 dB

Line code AMI, B8ZS

Clock source – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from RX1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±100 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse shape Terminated with 100  resistive load and 0 dB LBO selected, the interface
meets ITU-T Recommendation G.703 (11/01) and ANSI T1.102-1993

Physical measurements
Table 19 lists frequency and level measurement specifications when running DS1 applications.

Table 19 DS1 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Level V p-p Range: 8.0 V to 0.06 V


Accuracy: ± 0.04 V ± 10%
Resolution: 0.01 V

Frequency Range: 1.544 MHz ±250 ppm


Accuracy: ± 1.5 ppm, ± 1 ppm per year aging
Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

Level dBdsx1 Range: +2.5 dBdsx to -37 dBdsx


Resolution: 0.1 dB

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
132 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications

Table 19 DS1 frequency and level measurement specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Level dBm2 Range: +19.0 dBm to -10.5 dBm


Resolution: 0.1 dB

1. The designation dBdsx is a level measurement in dB relative to dsx level, which is 6 V peak-peak. A signal with a
peak-peak level of 6V corresponds to 0 dBdsx.
2. Available only when unframed all ones (AIS) signal is detected.

E1 specifications
When testing E1 circuits, either BNC or RJ48 connectors can be used.

NOTE:
The E1 and DS1 interfaces should not be connected at the same time. Multiple connections can
influence the integrity of the signal under test. After running your test, disconnect from one inter-
face before connecting to the other interface.

E1 (RJ-48) specifications
Table 20 through Table 22 on page 134 list specifications for the E1 (RJ-48) connector.

Receiver (RJ-48)
The E1 receiver operates as per ITU-G.703 (11/01). Table 20 lists the receiver specifications.

Table 20 E1 RJ-48 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector Balanced RJ-48

Bit rate 2.048 Mbps

Frequency measurement Range: 2.048 MHz ±250 ppm


Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Resolution: 1 Hz

Level Measurement Level Vp


(Balanced) Range: +4 V to 0.03 V
Accuracy: ±0.02 V ± 10%
Resolution: 0.01 V
Level dBnom1:
Range: +2.5 dBnom to -37 dBnom
Resolution: 0.1 dB

1. The designation in dBnom is relative to nominal signal 3 Vp.

Table 21 lists the input sensitivity specifications for the E1 receiver.

Table 21 E1 RJ-48 receiver sensitivity specifications


Termination Type Impedance Input Range

Bridge (HI-Z) >1200  +2.5 to -35 dBnom due to cable loss

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 133
Appendix A Specifications
T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications

Table 21 E1 RJ-48 receiver sensitivity specifications (Continued)


Termination Type Impedance Input Range

Terminate 120  balanced +2.5 to -35 dBnom due to cable loss

PMP 120  balanced -20 dBnom due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to -


6 dB due to cable loss

Transmitter (RJ-48)
The E1 transmitter operates as per ITU-G.703 (11/01). Table 22 lists the transmitter specifications.

Table 22 E1 RJ-48 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector Balanced RJ-48

Line code HDB3 or AMI

Bit rate Nominal: 2.048 Mbps


Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Frequency offset: ±100 ppm in 1 ppm steps

Clock Source – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from E1 RX1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±100 ppm in 1 ppm steps

Pulse shape Complies with ITU-T G.703 (11/01)

E3/DS3/STS-1 specifications
Refer to these tables for specifications for the E3/DS3/STS-1 connectors:

– Table 23 on page 134 through Table 25 on page 135 list specifications when running E3 appli-
cations.
– Table 26 on page 135 through Table 28 on page 136 list specifications when running DS3
applications.
– Table 29 on page 137 through Table 31 on page 137 list specifications when running STS-1
applications.

Receiver (E3 circuits)


Table 23 lists specifications for the receiver when running applications for E3 circuits.

Table 23 E3 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC (RX1)

Bit rate 34.368 Mbps

Impedance Nominal 75  at 17 MHz, unbalanced

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
134 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications

Table 23 E3 receiver specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Input Range Term: 0 to 12 dBnom due to cable loss at 17 MHz, from a nominal signal
PMP: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 12 dB due to cable loss
at 17 MHz, from a nominal signal

Transmitter (E3 circuits)


Table 24 lists specifications for the transmitter when running applications for E3 circuits.

Table 24 E3 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC (TX/RX2); used as transmitter only

Bit rate 34.368 Mbps

Line coding HDB3

Clock Source (Timing) – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
– Recovered from E3 Rx
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±100 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse Nominal 1.0 Vp Complies with ITU-T G.703 (11/01)

Impedance Nominal 75 

Level measurements (E3 circuits)


Table 25 lists frequency and level measurement specifications when running applications for E3
circuits.

Table 25 E3 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx Frequency Range: 34.368 MHz ±100 ppm


Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

Level Vp Range: 1.6 V to 0.01 V


Resolution: 0.01 V
Accuracy: ±0.02 V ±10%

Receiver (DS3 circuits)


Table 26 lists specifications for the receivers when running DS3 applications.

Table 26 DS3 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One RX1 BNC, and one TX/RX2 BNC; both BNCs can be used as receivers

Bit rate 44.736 Mbps

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 135
Appendix A Specifications
T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications

Table 26 DS3 receiver specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Impedance Nominal 75  at 22 MHz unbalanced

Input Range High/Low: 0 to 12 dB due to cable loss at 22 MHz, from a high signal
DSX/Monitor: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 9 dB due to
cable loss at 22MHz, from a High signal

Transmitter (DS3 circuits)


Table 27 lists specifications for the transmitter when running DS3 applications.

Table 27 DS3 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Output One BNC (TX/RX2); can be used as transmitter or receiver.

Bit rate 44.736 Mbps

Line coding B3ZS

Clock Source – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from DS3 Rx1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±100 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse (high) Nominal 1.15 Vp. Complies with ANSI T1.102-1993 and ITU-T G.703 (11/01)
after passing through 450 feet of RG59B/U cable.

Pulse (DSX) Nominal 0.6 Vp. Complies with ANSI T1.102-1993 and ITU-T G.703 (11/01).

Pulse (low) Nominal 0.35 Vp

Pulse shape With output terminated in 75  resistive load and DSX selected, the T-
BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800 meets ITU-T Recommendation G.703
(11/01) and ANSI T1.102-1993

Impedance Nominal 75 

Physical measurements (DS3 circuits)


Table 28 lists frequency, level, and jitter measurement specifications when running DS3 applica-
tions.

Table 28 DS3 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx – Range: 44.736 MHz ±100 ppm


frequency – Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
– Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

Level Vp – Range: 1.6 V to 0.01 V


– Resolution: 0.01 V
– Accuracy: ±0.02 V ±10%

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
136 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications

Receiver (STS-1 circuits)


Table 29 lists specifications for the receivers when running STS-1 applications.

Table 29 STS-1 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC (RX1)

Bit rate 51.84 Mbps

Impedance Nominal 75  at 26 MHz unbalanced


Range – High/Low: 0 to 12 dB due to cable loss at 26 MHz, from a high signal
– DSX/Monitor: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 9 dB due to
cable loss at 26 MHz, from a High signal

Transmitter (STS-1 circuits)


Table 30 lists specifications for the transmitter when running STS-1 applications.

Table 30 STS-1 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC (TX/RX2); used as transmitter only

Bit rate 51.84 Mbps

Line coding B3ZS

Clock Source – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from STS-1 Rx1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±50 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse (high) Nominal 1.15 Vp. Complies with ANSI T1.102-1993 and ITU-T G.703 (11/01)
after passing through 450 feet of RG59B/U cable.

Pulse (DSX) Nominal 0.6 Vp. Complies with ANSI T1.102-1993 and ITU-T G.703 (11/01).

Pulse (low) Nominal 0.32 Vp

Pulse shape With output terminated in 75  resistive load and DSX selected, the Dual Mod-
ule Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM meets ITU-T Recommendation
G.703 (11/01) and ANSI T1.102-1993

Impedance Nominal 75 

Physical measurements (STS-1 circuits)


Table 31 lists frequency and level measurement specifications when running STS-1 applications.

Table 31 STS-1 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx Range: 51.84 MHz ±50 ppm


frequency Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 137
Appendix A Specifications
T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications

Table 31 STS-1 frequency and level measurement specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Level Vp Range: 1.6 V to 0.01 V


Resolution: 0.01 V
Accuracy: ±0.02 V ±10%

E4/STM-1e specifications
Refer to these tables for specifications for the E4/STM-1e connector:

– Table 32 through Table 34 on page 139 list specifications for E4 receivers, transmitters, and
frequency and level measurements.
– Table 35 on page 139 through Table 37 on page 140 list specifications for STM-1e receivers,
transmitters, and frequency and level measurements.

Receiver (E4 circuits)


Table 32 lists specifications for the receiver when running E4 applications.

Table 32 E4 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC (RX1)

Bit rate 139.264 Mbps

Impedance Nominal 75  at 70 MHz unbalanced

Range – Term: 0 to 12 dB due to cable loss at 70 MHz, from a nominal signal


– Monitor: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 12 dB due to cable
loss at 70 MHz, from a nominal signal

Transmitter (E4 circuits)


Table 33 lists specifications for the transmitter when running E4 applications.

Table 33 E4 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC (TX/RX2); used as transmitter only

Bit rate 139.264 Mbps

Line coding CMI

Tx clock – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from E4 RX1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±50 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse Nominal 1.0 Vpp Complies with ITU-T G.703 (11/01)

Impedance Nominal 75 

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
138 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications

Physical measurements (E4 circuits)


Table 34 lists frequency and level measurement specifications when running E4 applications.

Table 34 E4 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx – Range: 139.264 MHz ±100 ppm


Frequency – Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
– Resolution: 1 Hz, or 1 ppm

Level Vpp – Range: 1.4 V to 0.01 V


– Resolution: 0.01 V
– Accuracy: ±0.02 V ±10%

Receiver (STM-1e circuits)


Table 35 lists specifications for the receiver when running STM-1e applications.

Table 35 STM-1e receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC (RX1)

Bit rate 155.52 Mbps

Impedance Nominal 75  at 78 MHz unbalanced

Range Term: 0 to 12.7 dB due to cable loss at 78 MHz, from a nominal signal
PMP: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 12.7 dB due to cable loss
at 70 MHz, from a nominal signal

Transmitter (STM-1e circuits)


Table 36 lists specifications for the transmitter when running STM-1e applications.

Table 36 STM-1e transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC (TX/RX2); used as transmitter only

Bit rate 155.52 Mbps

Line coding CMI

Tx clock – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from STM-1e RX1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±50 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse Nominal 1.0 Vpp Complies with ITU-T G.703 (11/01)

Impedance Nominal 75 

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 139
Appendix A Specifications
T-BERD / MTS 5800 specifications

Physical measurements (STM-1e circuits)


Table 37 lists frequency and level measurement specifications when running STM-1e applications.

Table 37 STM-1e frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx Frequency – Range: 155.52 MHz ±50 ppm


– Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
– Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

Level Vpp – Range: 1.4 V to 0.01 V


– Resolution: 0.01 V
– Accuracy: ±0.02 V ±10%

SFP/SFP+ specifications
The interfaces of the SFP comply with INF-8074i, Rev 1.0 published on May 12, 2001. The inter-
faces of the SFP+ comply with SFF-8431, Rev 4.1 published July 6, 2009. Performance is only
guaranteed when using JDSU Recommended Optics.

Supported optical rates


Table 38 provides the optical SONET, SDH, and Ethernet rates supported by the SFP/SFP+.

Table 38 SONET, SDH, and Ethernet rates


Rate SONET SDH Ethernet

4 Gbps N/A N/A N/A

2.5 Gbps OC-48 STM-16 N/A

2 Gbps N/A N/A N/A

1 Gbps N/A N/A 1 GigE

10 Gbps N/A N/A 10 GigE

622 Mbps OC-12 STM-4 N/A

155 Mbps OC-3 STM-1 N/A

100 Mbps N/A N/A 100M

Optical specifications
Table 39 lists specifications when testing optical circuits.

Table 39 Optical specifications


Item Description

Clock frequency accuracy ±1.5 ppm ±1 ppm per year aging

Transmitter frequency offset ±50 ppm from the nominal rate, in 1 ppm steps

Frequency measurement accuracy ±1.5 ppm ±1 ppm per year aging

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
140 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 39 Optical specifications (Continued)


Item Description

APS1
resolution 1ms
accuracy 1ms

RTD
resolution 1 s
accuracy 2 s

1. Published resolution and accuracy only ensured when using JDSU recommended transceivers (optics).

MSAM specifications
Refer to the following sections for specifications for the MSAM and each of the available PIMs:

– “Physical specifications” on page 141


– “Power supply specifications” on page 142
– “Battery specifications” on page 142
– “HS Datacom PIM specifications” on page 142
– “Diphase PIM specifications” on page 160
– “DS1 PIM specifications” on page 161
– “E1 (BNC) PIM specifications” on page 162
– “E1 (RJ-48) PIM specifications” on page 164
– “E3/DS3/STS-1 PIM specifications” on page 165
– “E4/STM-1e PIM specifications” on page 169
– “Interface Specifications- Jitter and Wander applications” on page 171
– “SFP PIM specifications” on page 171
– “XFP PIM specifications” on page 172
– “Optical specifications” on page 173
– “Clock source (Timing) specifications” on page 173

Physical specifications
The physical characteristics for the MSAM chassis are listed in Table 40.

Table 40 MSAM physical specifications


Item Description

Height 1.25 inches / 3.17 cm

Width 4.87 inches / 12.38 cm

Depth 9.12 inches / 23.49 cm

Weight (MSAM only) 1.8 lbs / 0.82 kg

Combined Weight (MSAM, 6000A Base Unit, one SFP 8.2 lbs / 3.72 kg
PIM, and one XFP PIM)

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 141
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Power supply specifications


Refer to the 6000A Base Unit User Manual for power supply specifications.

Battery specifications
Typical battery life when testing a single interface using a MSAM (inserted in a base unit) with a
single PIM ranges from at least one hour to two hours depending on the selected interface and test
application.

For detailed battery information, refer to the 6000A Base Unit User Manual.

HS Datacom PIM specifications


Table 41 on page 142 through Table 77 on page 159 provide specifications for the HS Datacom
PIM, and for each of the supported interfaces.

Clock input interface specifications


The clock input interface is a BNC connector that allows you to provide a clock from an external
source into the MSAM for interface timing. The external clock does not affect the MSAM’s internal
clock when measuring frequency. You can verify the clock in frequency by viewing the associated
result in the Signal test result category.

Table 41 provides specifications for the clock input interface.

Table 41 Clock input interface specifications


Item Description

Outer shell Ground

Inner conductor Clock input signal

Acceptable wave signals Square or sine waves

Minimum input 1.5 Vpp

Maximum input 5 Vpp with DC offset of 0 V

Termination 50 Ohm AC termination impedance

Frequency1 5 Hz to 25 MHz

Async signal frequency 16 times the baud rate. For example, an external clock generator
set to 153,600 Hz results in a 9600 baud signal out of the MSAM.

1. Line interfaces may not operate properly if the external clock is outside the supported frequency range for the inter-
face.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
142 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Clock output interface specifications


The clock output interface is a BNC connector that allows you to provide a clock for interface timing
from the MSAM. Table 42 provides specifications for the clock output interface.

Table 42 Clock output interface specifications


Item Description

Outer shell Ground

Inner conductor Clock output signal

Output signal1 Square wave

Minimum high level From 25 MHz:


– 2 Vpp into a 50 Ohm (+/-1%) load
– 4 Vpp unterminated

Maximum low level 600 mV when sinking 1 mA DC

Async signal frequency 16 times the baud rate. For example, an internally generated line
rate of 9600 baud causes a BNC clock out signal of 153,600 Hz.

1. A limited current is supplied to protect against short circuits.

Internal synthesizer specifications


Table 43 provides specifications for the MSAM’s internal synthesizer.

Table 43 Internal synthesizer specifications


Item Description

Accuracy +/- 1,5 ppm

+/- 1 ppm per year aging

Resolution 1 Hz

Synchronous data rate User selectable from 0.005 kHz to 20000 kHz, with a resolution of
1 Hz. See the Data Communications and Diphase Testing Man-
ual for the synthesizer frequencies supported for each interface.

X.21 interface specifications


Recommendation X.21 describes a data communications interface that uses balanced X.26 circuits
(equivalent to V.11) and unbalanced X.27 circuits (equivalent to V.10) circuits. The MSAM X.21
interface uses V.11 amplifiers.

Table 44 lists the MSAM X.21 interface specifications.

Table 44 X.21 interface specifications


Specification Description

Termination impedance 100 Ohm for balanced circuits, with 10% tolerance.

Timing modes Synchronous

Maximum speed 20 Mbps

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 143
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 44 X.21 interface specifications (Continued)


Specification Description

Minimum output range +/- 2 V terminated

Maximum input range +/- 12 V

Rise/Fall times – Clock/data: 6 ns


– Signaling: 10 ns

Receiver minimum input sensi- +/- 200 mV


tivity

Hysteresis Meets minimum input range

Supported circuits
Table 45 lists the X.21 circuits supported by the MSAM.

Table 45 X.21 circuits


Supported Circuits

C Request to Send

I Clear to Send

R Receive Data

S Receiver Signal Element Timing1

Shield

G Signal Ground

T Transmit Data

X Transmitter Signal Element Timing2

1. The equivalent of an STC circuit is not available in X.21; when testing a X.21 interface, select S instead.
2. Interchange Circuit X (DTE signal element timing = Transmit Clock) is provided per ISO 4903.

DTE emulation
Table 46 lists specifications for X.21 testing in DTE emulation mode.

Table 46 X.21 DTE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable lead C (Control lead)

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the S circuit)
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the S circuit)
– Interface Recovered
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
144 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

DCE emulation
Table 47 lists specifications for X.21 testing in DCE emulation mode.

Table 47 X.21 DCE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable lead I (Indication lead)

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the X circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the X circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

RS-232/V.24 interface specifications


Recommendation V.24 (equivalent to RS-232D and EIA-232D) describes a data communications
interface that uses unbalanced, bipolar, slew rate limited, V.28 amplifiers. Table 48 lists the MSAM
V.24 specifications.

Table 48 V.24 specifications


Specification Description

Termination source V.28 receiver

Timing modes – Synchronous


– Asynchronous

Maximum speed 256 Kbps

Minimum output range +/- 5 V loaded

Maximum input range +/- 15 V


Rise/Fall times 1.5 uS

Receiver minimum input sensitivity < 0.8 V, > 3.0 V

Hysteresis Meets minimum input range

Supported circuits
Table 49 lists the V.24 circuits supported by the MSAM.

Table 49 V.24 circuits


Supported Circuits

RTS Request to Send

ST Transmitter Element Signal Timing from DCE

TD Transmit Data

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 145
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 49 V.24 circuits (Continued)


Supported Circuits

DTR Data Terminal Ready

RD Receive Data

RI Ring Indicator

LL Local Loopback

Signal Ground

TT Transmitter Element Signal Timing to DCE

DSR Data Set Ready

RT Receiver Signal Element Timing

RLSD Receiver Line Signal Detect

RL Remote Loopback

TM Test Mode

DTE emulation
Table 50 lists specifications for V.24 testing in DTE emulation mode.

Table 50 V.24 DTE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RTS


– DTR
– LL
– RL

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the RT circuit)
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the RT circuit)
– Interface (from the ST circuit)
– Interface Recovered
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock

DCE emulation
Table 51 lists specifications for V.24 testing in DCE emulation mode.

Table 51 V.24 DCE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RLSD


– DSR
– CTS
– RI
– TM

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
146 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 51 V.24 DCE emulation specifications (Continued)


Specification Description

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the TT circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the TT circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

EIA-530/EIA-530A balanced interface specifications


Recommendation EIA-530/EIA-530A describes a data communications interface that uses
balanced V.11 amplifiers for clock and data circuits, and unbalanced V.10 amplifiers for signaling
circuits. Table 52 lists EIA-530/EIA-530A specifications for both balanced and unbalanced circuits.

Table 52 EIA-530/EIA-530A specifications


Specification Description

Timing modes Synchronous

Maximum speed 20 Mbps

Minimum output range


V.11 +/- 2 V terminated

V.10 +/- 4 V unterminated

Maximum input range


V.11 +/- 10 V

V.10 +/- 10 V

Rise/Fall times
V.11 10 nS

V.10 500 nS

Receiver minimum input sensitivity


V.11
+/- 200 mV
V.10
+/- 200 mV

Hysteresis Meets minimum input range

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 147
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 53 lists the EIA-530/EIA-530A termination specifications for balanced circuits.

Table 53 EIA-530/EIA-530A balanced circuit termination specifications


Specification Description

Termination options – unterminated


– 78 Ohm
– 100 Ohm
– 124 Ohm

Impedance – > 4 k Ohms unterminated circuits


– 10% tolerance, terminated

Supported circuits
Table 54 lists the EIA-530/EIA-530A circuits supported by the MSAM in balanced mode.

Table 54 EIA-530/EIA-530A balanced circuits


Supported Circuits

RTS Request to Send

ST Transmitter Element Signal Timing from DCE

TD Transmit Data

DTR Data Terminal Ready

RD Receive Data

RL Remote Loopback

TM Test Mode

Shield

CTS Clear to Send

TT Transmitter Element Signal Timing to DCE

DSR Data Set Ready

RT Receiver Signal Element Timing

RLSD Receiver Line Signal Detect

LL Local Loopback

Signal Ground

RI Ring Indicator (for EIA-530A only)

DTE emulation
Table 55 lists specifications for EIA-530/EIA-530A balanced testing in DTE emulation mode.

Table 55 EIA-530/EIA-530A balanced DTE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RTS


– DTR
– LL
– RL

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
148 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 55 EIA-530/EIA-530A balanced DTE emulation specifications (Continued)


Specification Description

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the RT circuit)
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the RT circuit)
– Interface (from the ST circuit)
– Interface Recovered
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock

DCE emulation
Table 56 lists specifications for balanced EIA-530/EIA-530A testing in DCE emulation mode.

Table 56 EIA-530/EIA-530A balanced DCE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RLSD


– DSR
– CTS
– TM
– RI (for EIA-530A only)

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the TT circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the TT circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

EIA-530/EIA-530A unbalanced interface specifications


Recommendation EIA-530/EIA-530A describes a data communications interface that uses unbal-
anced V.10 amplifiers for all circuits. Table 57 lists the MSAM EIA-530/EIA-530A unbalanced termi-
nation source and timing modes.

Table 57 EIA-530/EIA-530A unbalanced termination and timing modes


Specification Description

Maximum speed 256 Kbps

Termination V.10 amplifier

Timing modes Synchronous

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 149
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Supported circuits
Table 58 lists the EIA-530/EIA-530A circuits supported by the MSAM in unbalanced mode.

Table 58 EIA-530/EIA-530A unbalanced mode circuits


Supported Circuits

RTS Request to Send

ST Transmitter Element Signal Timing from DCE

TD Transmit Data

DTR Data Terminal Ready

RD Receive Data

RL Remote Loopback

TM Test Mode

Shield

CTS Clear to Send

TT Transmitter Element Signal Timing to DCE

DSR Data Set Ready

RT Receiver Signal Element Timing

RLSD Receiver Line Signal Detect

LL Local Loopback

Signal Ground

RI Ring Indicator (for EIA-530A only)

DTE emulation
Table 59 lists specifications for EIA-530/EIA-530A unbalanced testing in DTE emulation mode.

Table 59 EIA-530/EIA-530A unbalanced DTE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RTS


– DTR
– LL
– RL

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the RT circuit)
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the RT circuit)
– Interface (from the TT circuit)
– Interface Recovered
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
150 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

DCE emulation
Table 60 lists specifications for unbalanced EIA-530/EIA-530A testing in DCE emulation mode.

Table 60 EIA-530/EIA-530A unbalanced DCE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RLSD


– DSR
– CTS
– TM
– RI (for EIA-530A only)

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the TT circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the TT circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

MIL-188c interface specifications


Specification MIL-188c, published in 1969, describes a data communications interface that uses a
25 pin connector, and unbalanced MIL-188c amplifiers for all circuits. The MSAM supports testing
of unterminated MIL-188c circuits. Table 61 lists the MIL-188c specifications.

Table 61 MIL-188c specifications


Specification Description

Timing Modes Synchronous

Maximum speed 64 Kbps

Minimum output range +/- 5 V loaded

Maximum input range +/- 15 V

Rise/Fall times 1.5 uS

Receiver minimum input sensitivity < 0.8 V, > 3.0 V

Hysteresis Meets minimum input range

Supported circuits
Table 62 lists the unbalanced MIL-188c circuits supported by the MSAM.

Table 62 Unbalanced MIL-188c circuits


Supported Circuits

RTS Request to Send

ST Transmitter Element Signal Timing from DCE

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 151
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 62 Unbalanced MIL-188c circuits (Continued)


Supported Circuits

TD Transmit Data

DTR Data Terminal Ready

RD Receive Data

RL Remote Loopback

TM Test Mode

Shield

CTS Clear to Send

TT Transmitter Element Signal Timing to DCE

DSR Data Set Ready

RT Receiver Signal Element Timing

RLSD Receiver Line Signal Detect

LL Local Loopback

Signal Ground

RI Ring Indicator

DTE emulation
Table 63 lists specifications for MIL-188c testing in DTE emulation mode.

Table 63 MIL-188c DTE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RTS


– DTR
– LL
– RL

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the RT circuit)
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the RT circuit)
– Interface (from the ST circuit)
– Interface Recovered
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
152 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

DCE emulation
Table 64 lists specifications for MIL-188c testing in DCE emulation mode.

Table 64 MIL-188c DCE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RLSD


– DSR
– CTS
– TM
– RI

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the TT circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the TT circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

V.35 interface specifications


Recommendation V.35 is primarily a modem specification; however, it also describes a data
communications interface that uses balanced V.35 amplifiers for clock and data circuits, and unbal-
anced V.28 amplifiers for signaling circuits. Table 65 lists the V.35 specifications for balanced and
unbalanced circuits.

Table 65 V.35 specifications


Specification Description

Timing modes Synchronous

Maximum speed 15 Mbps

Minimum output range


V.35 +/- 0.44 V terminated

V.28 +/- 5 V

Rise/Fall times
V.35 < 10 nS

V.28 1.5 uS

Receiver minimum input sensitivity


V.35
+/- 200 mV
V.28
< 0.8 V, > 3.0 V

Hysteresis Meets minimum input range

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 153
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 66 lists the MSAM V.35 termination specifications.

Table 66 V.35 circuit termination specifications


Specification Description

Balanced receivers
Termination 100 Ohm
Impedance +/- 20%

Unbalanced receivers
Load impedance 3k to 7 k Ohms
Maximum input voltage +/- 15 V

Signaling polarity ON: greater than +3 V dc


OFF: open or less than -3 V dc

Supported circuits
Table 67 lists the V.35 circuits supported by the MSAM.

Table 67 V.35 circuits


Supported Circuits

RTS Request to Send

SCT Transmitter Element Signal Timing from DCE

SD Transmit Data

DTR Data Terminal Ready

RD Receive Data

RL Remote Loopback

TM Test Mode

Shield

CTS Clear to Send

SCTE Transmitter Element Signal Timing to DCE

DSR Data Set Ready

SCR Receiver Signal Element Timing

RLSD Receiver Line Signal Detect

LL Local Loopback

Signal Ground

RI Ring

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
154 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

DTE emulation
Table 68 lists specifications for V.35 testing in DTE emulation mode.

Table 68 V.35 DTE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RTS


– DTR
– LL
– RL

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the SCR circuit)
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the SCT circuit)
– Interface (from the SCR circuit)
– Interface Recovered
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock

DCE emulation
Table 69 lists specifications for V.35 testing in DCE emulation mode.

Table 69 V.35 DCE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RLSD


– DSR
– CTS
– TM
– CI

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the SCTE-306 circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the SCTE-306 circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

RS-449/V.36 specifications
Recommendation V.36 (equivalent to RS-449) is primarily a modem specification; however, it also
describes a data communications interface that uses balanced V.11 amplifiers for all circuits except
test mode circuits. The V.36 test mode circuits use unbalanced V.10 amplifiers. V.10 amplifiers can
also be used for signaling circuits. When V.10 amplifiers are used for signaling, the B lead is
grounded internally in the MSAM.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 155
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 70 lists the MSAM V.36 specifications.

Table 70 V.36 specifications


Specification Description

Maximum speed Balanced


– 20 Mbps
Unbalanced
– 64 Kbps

Termination options – unterminated


– 78 Ohm
– 100 Ohm
– 124 Ohm

Impedance – > 4 k Ohmunterminated circuits


– 10% tolerance, terminated

Minimum output range


V.11 +/- 2 V terminated

V.10 +/- 4 V unterminated

Maximum input range


V.11 +/- 10 V

V.10 +/- 10 V
Rise/Fall times
V.11 10 nS

V.10 500 nS

Receiver minimum input sensitivity


V.11 +/- 200 mV

V.10 +/- 200 mV

Hysteresis Meets minimum input range

Supported circuits
Table 71 lists the V.36 circuits supported by the MSAM.

Table 71 V.36 circuits


Supported Circuits

RS Request to Send

ST Transmitter Element Signal Timing from DCE

SD Transmit Data

TR Data Terminal Ready

RD Receive Data

RL Remote Loopback

TM Test Mode

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
156 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 71 V.36 circuits (Continued)


Supported Circuits

Shield

CS Clear to Send

TT Transmitter Element Signal Timing to DCE

DM Data Set Ready

RT Receiver Signal Element Timing

RR Receiver Line Signal Detect

LL Local Loopback

Signal Ground

IC Ring Indicator

DTE emulation
Table 72 lists specifications for V.36 testing in DTE emulation mode.

Table 72 V.36 DTE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RS


– TR
– LL
– RL

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the RT circuit)
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the RT circuit)
– Interface (from the ST circuit)
– Interface Recovered
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock

DCE emulation
Table 73 lists specifications for V.36 testing in DCE emulation mode.

Table 73 V.36 DCE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RR


– DM
– CS
– TM
– IC (37 pin connector only)

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 157
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 73 V.36 DCE emulation specifications (Continued)


Specification Description

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the TT circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the TT circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

MIL-188-114 interface specifications


Specification MIL-188-114 describes a data communications interface that uses DB-25 connector
or DB-37 connectors using balanced or unbalanced MIL-188-114 amplifiers for all circuits. The
MSAM supports testing of MIL-188-114 circuits in asynchronous or synchronous mode. Table 74
lists the MIL-188-114 specifications.

Table 74 MIL-188-114 specifications


Specification Description

Timing modes Synchronous

Maximum speed
Balanced 20 Mbps

Unbalanced 256 Kbps

Minimum output range +/- 2 V terminated

Rise/Fall times 10 nS

Receiver minimum input sensitivity +/- 200 mV

Hysteresis Meets minimum input range

Supported circuits
Table 75 lists the unbalanced MIL-188-114 circuits supported by the MSAM.

Table 75 Unbalanced MIL-188-114 circuits


Supported Circuits

RS Request to Send

ST Transmitter Element Signal Timing from DCE

SD Transmit Data

TR Data Terminal Ready

RD Receive Data

RL Remote Loopback

TM Test Mode

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
158 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 75 Unbalanced MIL-188-114 circuits (Continued)


Supported Circuits

Shield

CS Clear to Send

TT Transmitter Element Signal Timing to DCE

DM Data Set Ready

RT Receiver Signal Element Timing

RR Receiver Line Signal Detect

LL Local Loopback

Signal Ground

IC Ring Indicator

DTE emulation
Table 76 lists specifications for MIL-188-114 testing in DTE emulation mode.

Table 76 MIL-188-114 DTE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RS


– TR
– LL
– RL

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the RT circuit)
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the RT circuit)
– Interface (from the ST circuit)
– Interface Recovered
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock

DCE emulation
Table 77 lists specifications for MIL-188-114 testing in DCE emulation mode.

Table 77 MIL-188-114 DCE emulation specifications


Specification Description

User controllable leads – RR


– DM
– CS
– TM
– IC (37 pin connector only)

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 159
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 77 MIL-188-114 DCE emulation specifications (Continued)


Specification Description

Sync Timing Mode


Rx Timing Sources – Interface (from the TT circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

Sync Timing Mode


Tx Timing Sources – Interface (from the TT circuit)
– Internal Synthesizer
– External Clock
– Interface Recovered

Diphase PIM specifications


Table 78 on page 160 and Table 79 on page 161 provide specifications for the Diphase PIM.

Receiver specifications
Table 78 lists receiver specifications for the Conditioned Diphase PIM.

Table 78 Receiver specifications


Item Description

Signal level 6.0 Vrms (+6 dB) to 90 mVrms (-30 dB)

Termination User selectable, +/- 20%


– 58 Ohms
– 130 Ohms
– Bridge (>2 Kohms)

Pull range +/- 600 ppm


NOTE: The Frequency History result appears in the Summary result cat-
egory if the measured receive frequency deviates +/- 150 ppm from the
expected frequency.

Signal recovery 128/256/512 kbps


(per MIL-188-202) – 3.2 Km of coaxial cable
2048 kbps
– 1.6 Km of coaxial cable
64 Kbps
– 2 Km of twisted pair cable

Cable loss Up to 30 dB at all data rates


compensation

Signal present Declared if transitions are > +/- 90 mV.


NOTE: Valid signal indication is guaranteed if frequency offset is
<600 ppm.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
160 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Transmitter specifications
Table 79 lists transmitter specifications for the Conditioned Diphase interface module.

Table 79 Transmitter specifications


Item Description

Timing source User selectable


– Rx (Recovered)
– Internal (Rate)

Output level +/- 3 Vp +/-15% when terminated into 58 or 130 Ohms

DS1 PIM specifications


Table 80 on page 161 through Table 83 on page 162 list specifications for the DS1 PIM.

Receiver
Table 80 lists specifications for the DS1 receivers.

Table 80 DS1 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One RX1 Bantam Jack, and one TX/RX2 Bantam jack; both jacks
can be used as receivers

Bit rate 1544 kbps ±250 ppm

Line coding AMI, B8ZS

Table 81 lists the input sensitivity specifications for the DS1 receiver.

Table 81 DS1 receiver sensitivity specifications


Termination Type Impedance Input Range

Bridge >1000  +6 to -35.0 dBdsx due to cable loss


Terminate 100  nom +6 to -35.0 dBdsx due to cable loss

DSX monitor 100  nom -20 dBdsx due to resistive loss in addition to
0 to -6 dB due to cable loss

Transmitter
Table 82 lists specifications for the DS1 transmitter.

Table 82 DS1 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One TX/RX2 Bantam jack; only the TX/RX2 jack can be used as a transmitter

Output 6 Vnom peak-peak into 100 


Complies with ANSI T1.403-1999.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 161
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 82 DS1 transmitter specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Line build out 0 dB, -7.5 dB, -15.0 dB or -22.5 dB due to cable loss at 772 kHz
(LBO) level

LBO level accuracy At 772 kHz relative to the signal at 0 dBdsx:


– ± 2.5 dB for -7.5 dB
– ±3 dB for -15.0 dB and -22.5 dB

Line code AMI, B8ZS

Clock source – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from RX1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±100 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse shape Terminated with 100  resistive load and 0 dB LBO selected, the interface
meets ITU-T Recommendation G.703 (11/01) and ANSI T1.102-1993

Physical measurements
Table 83 lists frequency and level measurement specifications when running DS1 applications.

Table 83 DS1 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Level V p-p Range: 8.0 V to 0.06 V


Accuracy: ± 0.04 V ± 10%
Resolution: 0.01 V

Frequency Range: 1.544 MHz ±250 ppm


Accuracy: ± 1.5 ppm, ± 1 ppm per year aging
Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

Level dBdsx1 Range: +2.5 dBdsx to -37 dBdsx


Resolution: 0.1 dB

Level dBm2 Range: +19.0 dBm to -10.5 dBm


Resolution: 0.1 dB

1. The designation dBdsx is a level measurement in dB relative to dsx level, which is 6 V peak-peak. A signal with a
peak-peak level of 6V corresponds to 0 dBdsx.
2. Available only when unframed all ones (AIS) signal is detected.

E1 (BNC) PIM specifications


Table 84 on page 163 through Table 87 on page 164 list specifications for the E1 (BNC) PIM.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
162 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Receiver (BNC)
The E1 receiver operates as per ITU-G.703 (11/01). Table 84 lists the receiver specifications.

Table 84 E1 BNC receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One unbalanced RX1 BNC, and one unbalanced TX/RX2 BNC; both
BNCs can be used as receivers

Bit rate 2.048 Mbps

Frequency measurement Range: 2.048 MHz ±250 ppm


Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Resolution: 1 Hz

Level Measurement (Unbal- Level Vp


anced) Range: +4.0 V to 0.03 V
Accuracy: ±0.02 V ± 10%
Resolution: 0.01 V
Level dBnom1:
Range: 4.5 dBnom to -37 dBnom
Resolution: 0.1 dB

1. The designation in dBnom is relative to nominal signal 2.37 Vp.

Table 85 lists the input sensitivity specifications for the E1 receiver.

Table 85 E1 receiver sensitivity specifications


Termination Type Impedance Input Range

Bridge (HI-Z) >750  +4 to -35 dBnom due to cable loss

Terminate 75  unbalanced +4 to -35 dBnom due to cable loss

PMP 75  unbalanced -20 dBnom due to resistive loss in addition to


0 to -6 dB due to cable loss

Transmitter (BNC)
The E1 transmitter operates as per ITU-G.703 (11/01). Table 86 lists the transmitter specifications.

Table 86 E1 BNC transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One unbalanced BNC/ 75 ; only the TX/RX2 BNC can be used as a
transmitter

Line code HDB3 or AMI

Bit rate Nominal: 2.048 Mbps


Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Frequency offset: ±100 ppm in 1 ppm steps

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 163
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 86 E1 BNC transmitter specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Clock Source – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year
(Timing) aging
– Recovered from Rx1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK
– BITS
1.544 Mbps DS1/T1 signal
– SETS
2.048 Mbps E1 signal
– 2MClock
2.048 MHz G.703 sync clock (square wave)
– 10M Clock
10.000 MHz square clock

Frequency offset ±100 ppm in 1 ppm steps

Pulse shape Complies with ITU-T G.703 (11/01)

E1 (RJ-48) PIM specifications


Table 87 on page 164 through Table 89 on page 165 list specifications for the E1 (BNC) PIM.

Receiver (RJ-48)
The E1 receiver operates as per ITU-G.703 (11/01). Table 87 lists the receiver specifications.

Table 87 E1 RJ-48 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector Balanced RJ-48

Bit rate 2.048 Mbps

Frequency measurement Range: 2.048 MHz ±250 ppm


Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Resolution: 1 Hz
Level Measurement Level Vp
(Balanced) Range: +4 V to 0.03 V
Accuracy: ±0.02 V ± 10%
Resolution: 0.01 V
Level dBnom1:
Range: +2.5 dBnom to -37 dBnom
Resolution: 0.1 dB

1. The designation in dBnom is relative to nominal signal 3 Vp.

Table 88 lists the input sensitivity specifications for the E1 receiver.

Table 88 E1 RJ-48 receiver sensitivity specifications


Termination Type Impedance Input Range

Bridge (HI-Z) >1200  +2.5 to -35 dBnom due to cable loss

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
164 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 88 E1 RJ-48 receiver sensitivity specifications (Continued)


Termination Type Impedance Input Range

Terminate 120  balanced +2.5 to -35 dBnom due to cable loss

PMP 120  balanced -20 dBnom due to resistive loss in addition to


0 to -6 dB due to cable loss

Transmitter (RJ-48)
The E1 transmitter operates as per ITU-G.703 (11/01). Table 89 lists the transmitter specifications.

Table 89 E1 RJ-48 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector Balanced RJ-48

Line code HDB3 or AMI


Bit rate Nominal: 2.048 Mbps
Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Frequency offset: ±100 ppm in 1 ppm steps

Clock Source – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year
(Timing) aging
– Recovered from Rx1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±100 ppm in 1 ppm steps

Pulse shape Complies with ITU-T G.703 (11/01)

E3/DS3/STS-1 PIM specifications


Refer to these tables for specifications for the E3/DS3/STS-1 PIM:

– Table 90 on page 165 through Table 91 on page 166 list specifications when running E3 appli-
cations.
– Table 93 on page 166 through Table 95 on page 167 list specifications when running DS3
applications.
– Table 96 on page 168 through Table 98 on page 169 list specifications when running STS-1
applications.

Receiver (E3 circuits)


Table 90 lists specifications for the receiver when running applications for E3 circuits.

Table 90 E3 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC (RX1)

Bit rate 34.368 Mbps

Impedance Nominal 75  at 17 MHz, unbalanced

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 165
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 90 E3 receiver specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Input Range Term: 0 to 12 dBnom due to cable loss at 17 MHz, from a nominal signal
PMP: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 12 dB due to cable
loss at 17 MHz, from a nominal signal

Transmitter (E3 circuits)


Table 91 lists specifications for the transmitter when running applications for E3 circuits.

Table 91 E3 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC (TX/RX2); used as transmitter only

Bit rate 34.368 Mbps

Line coding HDB3


Clock Source (Timing) – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year
aging
– Recovered from E3 Rx
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±100 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse Nominal 1.0 Vp Complies with ITU-T G.703 (11/01)

Impedance Nominal 75 

Level measurements (E3 circuits)


Table 92 lists frequency and level measurement specifications when running applications for E3
circuits.

Table 92 E3 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx Frequency Range: 34.368 MHz ±100 ppm


Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

Level Vp Range: 1.6 V to 0.01 V


Resolution: 0.01 V
Accuracy: ±0.05 V ±10%

Receiver (DS3 circuits)


Table 93 lists specifications for the receivers when running DS3 applications.

Table 93 DS3 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One RX1 BNC, and one TX/RX2 BNC; both BNCs can be used as receivers

Bit rate 44.736 Mbps

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
166 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 93 DS3 receiver specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Impedance Nominal 75  at 22 MHz unbalanced

Input Range High/Low: 0 to 12 dB due to cable loss at 22 MHz, from a high signal
DSX/Monitor: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 9 dB due to cable
loss at 22MHz, from a High signal

Transmitter (DS3 circuits)


Table 94 lists specifications for the transmitter when running DS3 applications.

Table 94 DS3 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Output One BNC (TX/RX2); can be used as transmitter or receiver.

Bit rate 44.736 Mbps


Line coding B3ZS

Clock Source – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from DS3 Rx1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±100 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse (high) Nominal 1.15 Vp. Complies with ANSI T1.102-1993 and ITU-T G.703 (11/01)
after passing through 450 feet of RG59B/U cable.

Pulse (DSX) Nominal 0.6 Vp. Complies with ANSI T1.102-1993 and ITU-T G.703 (11/01).

Pulse (low) Nominal 0.35 Vp

Pulse shape With output terminated in 75  resistive load and DSX selected, the T-
BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800 meets ITU-T Recommendation G.703
(11/01) and ANSI T1.102-1993

Impedance Nominal 75 

Physical measurements (DS3 circuits)


Table 95 lists frequency, level, and jitter measurement specifications when running DS3 applica-
tions.

Table 95 DS3 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx – Range: 44.736 MHz ±100 ppm


frequency – Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
– Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

Level Vp – Range: 1.6 V to 0.01 V


– Resolution: 0.01 V
– Accuracy: ±0.05 V ±10%

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 167
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Receiver (STS-1 circuits)


Table 96 lists specifications for the receivers when running STS-1 applications.

Table 96 STS-1 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC (RX1)

Bit rate 51.84 Mbps

Impedance Nominal 75  at 26 MHz unbalanced


Range – High/Low: 0 to 12 dB due to cable loss at 26 MHz, from a high sig-
nal
– DSX/Monitor: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 9 dB
due to cable loss at 26 MHz, from a High signal

Transmitter (STS-1 circuits)


Table 97 lists specifications for the transmitter when running STS-1 applications.

Table 97 STS-1 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC (TX/RX2); used as transmitter only

Bit rate 51.84 Mbps

Line coding B3ZS

Clock Source – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year
(Timing) aging
– Recovered from STS-1 Rx1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±50 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse (high) Nominal 1.15 Vp. Complies with ANSI T1.102-1993 and ITU-T G.703
(11/01) after passing through 450 feet of RG59B/U cable.

Pulse (DSX) Nominal 0.6 Vp. Complies with ANSI T1.102-1993 and ITU-T G.703
(11/01).

Pulse (low) Nominal 0.32 Vp

Pulse shape With output terminated in 75  resistive load and DSX selected, the
Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM meets ITU-T Rec-
ommendation G.703 (11/01) and ANSI T1.102-1993

Impedance Nominal 75 

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
168 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Physical measurements (STS-1 circuits)


Table 98 lists frequency and level measurement specifications when running STS-1 applications.

Table 98 STS-1 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx frequency Range: 51.84 MHz ±50 ppm


Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

Level Vp Range: 1.6 V to 0.01 V


Resolution: 0.01 V
Accuracy: ±0.05 V ±10%

E4/STM-1e PIM specifications


Refer to these tables for specifications for the E4/STM-1e PIM:

– Table 99 on page 169 through Table 101 on page 170 list specifications for E4 receivers, trans-
mitters, and frequency and level measurements.
– Table 102 on page 170 through Table 104 on page 171 list specifications for STM-1 receivers,
transmitters, and frequency and level measurements.

Receiver (E4 circuits)


Table 99 lists specifications for the receiver when running E4 applications.

Table 99 E4 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC

Bit rate 139.264 Mbps

Impedance Nominal 75  at 70 MHz unbalanced

Range – Term: 0 to 12 dB due to cable loss at 70 MHz, from a nominal signal


– PMP: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 12 dB due to cable
loss at 70 MHz, from a nominal signal

Transmitter (E4 circuits)


Table 100 lists specifications for the transmitter when running E4 applications.

Table 100 E4 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC

Bit rate 139.264 Mbps

Line coding CMI

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 169
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 100 E4 transmitter specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Tx clock – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year
(Timing) aging
– Recovered from E4 Rx
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±50 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse Nominal 1.0 Vpp Complies with ITU-T G.703 (11/01)

Impedance Nominal 75 

Physical measurements (E4 circuits)


Table 101 lists frequency and level measurement specifications when running E4 applications.

Table 101 E4 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx – Range: 139.264 MHz ±100 ppm


Frequency – Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
– Resolution: 1 Hz, or 1 ppm

Level Vpp – Range: 1.4 V to 0.01 V


– Resolution: 0.01 V
– Accuracy: ±0.05 V ±10%

Receiver (STM-1e circuits)


Table 102 lists specifications for the receiver when running STM-1e applications.

Table 102 STM-1e receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC

Bit rate 155.52 Mbps

Impedance Nominal 75  at 78 MHz unbalanced

Range Term: 0 to 12.7 dB due to cable loss at 78 MHz, from a nominal signal
PMP: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 12.7 dB due to cable
loss at 70 MHz, from a nominal signal

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
170 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Transmitter (STM-1e circuits)


Table 103 lists specifications for the transmitter when running STM-1e applications.

Table 103 STM-1e transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector One BNC

Bit rate 155.52 Mbps

Line coding CMI


Tx clock – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from Rx1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±50 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse Nominal 1.0 Vpp Complies with ITU-T G.703 (11/01)

Impedance Nominal 75 

Physical measurements (STM-1e circuits)


Table 104 lists frequency and level measurement specifications when running STM-1e applications.

Table 104 STM-1e frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx – Range: 155.52 MHz ±50 ppm


Frequency – Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
– Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

Level Vpp – Range: 1.4 V to 0.01 V


– Resolution: 0.01 V
– Accuracy: ±0.05 V ±10%

Interface Specifications- Jitter and Wander applications


The electrical and optical interface specifications for MSAM Jitter and Wander applications are
detailed in “Jitter and Wander specifications” on page 187.

SFP PIM specifications


The interfaces of the SFP PIM comply with INF-8074i, Rev 1.0 published on May 12, 2001. Perfor-
mance is only guaranteed when using JDSU Recommended Optics.

Supported electrical rates


The 10/100/1000 Base-T/Tx interfaces conform to the IEEE 802.3 electrical requirements.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 171
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Table 105 lists the electrical rates supported by the SFP PIM.

Table 105 Electrical rates


Rate Mbps

10Base-T Ethernet 10

100Base-T Ethernet 100

1000Base-T Ethernet 1000

Electrical interface specifications


Table 106 lists the electrical specifications for the 10/100/
1000 Mb/s interface.

Table 106 10/100/1000 Mb/s interface specifications


Specification Description

Cable CAT5e 100-Ohm STP cable, < 100 meters

Supported optical rates


Table 107 provides the optical SONET, SDH, OTN, Ethernet, and Fibre Channel rates supported by
the SFP PIM.

Table 107 SONET, SDH, OTN, Ethernet, and Fibre Channel rates
Rate SONET SDH OTN Ethernet Fibre Channel

4 Gbps N/A N/A N/A N/A 4Gig

2.5 Gbps OC-48 STM-16 2.7 Gbps N/A N/A

2 Gbps N/A N/A N/A N/A 2Gig

1 Gbps N/A N/A N/A 1 GigE 1Gig

622 Mbps OC-12 STM-4 N/A N/A N/A

155 Mbps OC-3 STM-1 N/A N/A N/A

100 Mbps N/A N/A N/A 100M N/A

XFP PIM specifications


The interface of the XFP PIM complies with INF-8077i, Rev 4.5 published on August 31, 2005.
Performance is only guaranteed when using JDSU Recommended Optics.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
172 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
MSAM specifications

Supported optical rates


The XFP PIM supports the 10 Gigabit optical interfaces listed in Table 108.

Table 108 SONET, SDH, OTN, Ethernet, and Fibre Channel rates
Rate SONET SDH OTN Ethernet Fibre Channel

10 Gbps OC-192 STM-64 10.7 Gbps 10GigE 8Gig


11.1 Gbps 10Gig
11.05 Gbps

Optical specifications
Table 109 lists specifications for the available PIMs when testing optical circuits.

Table 109 Optical specifications


Item Description

Clock frequency accuracy ±1.5 ppm ±1 ppm per year aging

Transmitter frequency offset ±50 ppm from the nominal rate, in 1 ppm steps

Frequency measurement accuracy ±1.5 ppm ±1 ppm per year aging

APS1
resolution 1ms
accuracy 1ms

RTD
resolution 1 s
accuracy 2 s

1. Published resolution and accuracy only ensured when using JDSU recommended transceivers (optics).

Clock source (Timing) specifications


Table 110 lists internal and external timing specifications for the MSAM chassis.

Table 110 Timing specifications


Clock Source Description

Internal reference accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging

External BNC from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 173
Appendix A Specifications
Transport Module specifications

Transport Module specifications


Refer to the following sections for specifications for the Transport Module:

– “Physical specifications” on page 174


– “Power supply specifications” on page 175
– “Battery specifications” on page 175
– “DS1 electrical specifications” on page 175
– “E1 (2M) electrical specifications” on page 177
– “E3 electrical specifications” on page 179
– “DS3 electrical specifications” on page 180
– “STS-1 electrical specifications” on page 181
– “E4 electrical specifications” on page 182
– “STM-1 electrical specifications” on page 183
– “10/100/1000Base T electrical specifications” on page 184
– “Optical specifications” on page 185
– “Interface Specifications- Jitter and Wander applications” on page 171
– “Interface specifications- Non-Jitter and Wander applications” on page 185

Physical specifications
The physical characteristics for the Transport Module (fully configured) are described in Table 111.

Table 111 Module physical specifications


Item 5cm Transport Module 10 cm Transport Module

Height 2.13 in / 5.41 cm 4.10 in / 10.41 cm

Width 12.16 in / 30.88 cm 12.16 in / 30.88 cm

Depth 9.96 in / 25.3 cm 9.96 in / 25.3 cm

Weight 5.5 lbs / 2.5 kg 9.15 lbs / 4.1 kg

Table 112 describes the physical characteristics for the Transport Module when attached to the
base unit and the battery module with two batteries installed.

Table 112 Combined physical specifications


Item 5cm Transport Module 10 cm Transport Module

Height 5.8 in / 14.73 cm 7.67 in / 19.3 cm

Width 12.16 in / 30.88 cm 12.16 in / 30.88 cm

Depth 9.96 in / 25.3 cm 9.96 in / 25.3 cm

Weight 14.69 lbs / 6.6 kg 19.0 lbs / 8.4 kg

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
174 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Transport Module specifications

Power supply specifications


Table 113 describes the specifications for the 150W power supply.

Table 113 Power supply specifications


Item 150W power supply

Input, nominal range 100-240 V. 50-60 Hz, 2A

Maximum power draw 150 watts

Battery specifications
To ensure the maximum operating time is obtained while testing using the Transport Module, if you
are not using the power adapter, be certain to install two batteries in the battery module. Different
tests deplete the batteries at different rates; therefore, when performing more than one BER test,
or any Jitter test, battery life can not be guaranteed for any specific length of time. Always use the
power supply when multiple modules are attached or if two MSAMs are used in one DMC module.

Electrical specifications
Table 114 lists the electrical rates supported by the Transport Module.

Table 114 Electrical rates


Rate Mbps

DS1 1.544

DS3 44.736

E1 2.048

E3 34.368

E4 139.264

STS-1 51.84

STM-1e 155.52

10Base-T Ethernet 10

100Base-T Ethernet 100

1000Base-T Ethernet 1000

Specifications for each of the electrical connectors (DS1, DS3, E1/2M, E3, and E4) are provided in
Table 115 on page 176 through Table 136 on page 184.

DS1 electrical specifications


Table 115 on page 176 through Table 118 on page 177 list specifications for DS1 receivers, trans-
mitters, and frequency and level measurements.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 175
Appendix A Specifications
Transport Module specifications

Receivers
Table 115 lists specifications for the Primary and Secondary DS1 receivers.

Table 115 DS1 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Connectors Two bantam jacks

Bit rate 1544 kbps ±250 ppm

Line coding AMI, B8ZS

Table 116 lists the input sensitivity specifications for the Primary and Secondary DS1 receivers.

Table 116 DS1 receiver sensitivity specifications


Termination Type Impedance Input Range

Bridge >1000  +6 to -35.0 dBdsx due to cable loss

Terminate 100  ±5% +6 to -35.0 dBdsx due to cable loss

DSX monitor 100  ±5% -20 dBdsx due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to
-6 dB due to cable loss

Transmitter
Table 117 lists specifications for the DS1 transmitter.

Table 117 DS1 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Connector Bantam jack

Output 6 V peak-peak into 100 

Line build out 0 dB, -7.5 dB, -15.0 dB or -22.5 dB due to cable loss at 772 kHz
(LBO) level

LBO level accuracy At 772 kHz relative to the signal at 0 dBdsx:


– ± 2.5 dB for -7.5 dB
– ±3 dB for -15.0 dB and -22.5 dB

Line code AMI, B8ZS

Clock source – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year
(Timing) aging
– Recovered from Rx1 or Rx2
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±100 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse shape With output terminated in 100  resistive load and 0 dB LBO selected,
the interface meets ITU-T Recommendation G.703 (11/01) and ANSI
T1.102-1993

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
176 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Transport Module specifications

Physical measurements
Table 118 lists frequency, level, and jitter measurement specifications for DS1.

Table 118 DS1 frequency, level, and jitter measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Level V p-p Range: 14.0 V to 0.06 V


Accuracy: ± 0.04 V ± 10%
Resolution: 0.01 V

Frequency Range: 1.544 MHz ±250 ppm


Accuracy: ± 1.5 ppm, ± 1 ppm per year aging
Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

Level dBdsx1 Range: +7.3 dBdsx to -37 dBdsx


Resolution: 0.1 dB

Level dBm2 Range: +23.8 dBm to -10.5 dBm


Resolution: 0.1 dB

1. The designation dBdsx is a level measurement in dB relative to dsx level, which is 6 V peak-peak. A signal with a
peak-peak level of 6V corresponds to 0 dBdsx.
2. Available only when unframed all ones (AIS) signal is detected.

E1 (2M) electrical specifications


Table 119 on page 177 through Table 121 on page 178 list specifications for the E1 (2M) receivers
and transmitters.

Receivers
The E1 receivers operate as per ITU-G.703 (11/01). Table 119 lists the receiver specifications.

Table 119 E1 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Input One Balanced RJ-48 jack. Two Unbalanced BNC connectors. Sec-
ondary Input may also be used as an external E1 reference clock:
– 0.5 to 3 Vpp square or sine wave, 2.048 MHz, unbalanced/ 75 

Bit rate 2.048 Mbps

Frequency measurement Range: 2.048 MHz ±250 ppm


Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Resolution: 1 Hz

Level Measurement (Balanced) Level Vp


Range: +7 V to 0.03 V
Accuracy: ±0.02 V ± 10%
Resolution: 0.01 V
Level dBnom1:
Range: 7.3 dBnom to -37 dBnom
Resolution: 0.1 dB

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 177
Appendix A Specifications
Transport Module specifications

Table 119 E1 receiver specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Level Level Vp
Measurement (Unbalanced) Range: +5 V to 0.03 V
Accuracy: ±0.02 V ± 10%
Resolution: 0.01 V
Level dBnom2:
Range: 7.3 dBnom to -37 dBnom
Resolution: 0.1 dB

1. The designation in dBnom is relative to nominal signal 3 Vp.


2. The designation in dBnom is relative to nominal signal 2.37 Vp.

Table 120 lists the input sensitivity specifications for the E1 receivers.

Table 120 E1 receiver sensitivity specifications


Termination Type Impedance Input Range

Bridge (HI-Z) >1200  +6 to -35 dBnom due to cable loss

Terminate 120  balanced +6 to -35 dBnom due to cable loss


75  unbalanced

PMP 120  balanced -20 dBnom due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to


75  unbalanced -6 dB due to cable loss

Transmitters
The E1 transmitters operate as per ITU-G.703 (11/01). Table 121 describes the transmitter specifi-
cations.

Table 121 E1 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Output One balanced RJ-48 jack


Impedance 120 W
One unbalanced BNC connector/ 75 W

Line code HDB3 or AMI

Bit rate Nominal: 2.048 Mbps


Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Frequency offset: ±100 ppm in 1 ppm steps

Clock Source – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from Rx1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency ±100 ppm in 1 ppm steps


offset

Pulse shape Complies with ITU-T G.703 (11/01)

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
178 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Transport Module specifications

E3 electrical specifications
Table 122 on page 179 through Table 124 on page 179 list specifications for E3 receivers, transmit-
ters, and frequency and level measurements.

Receiver
Table 122 lists specifications for the E3 receiver.

Table 122 E3 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Input One BNC connector

Bit rate 34.368 Mbps

Impedance Nominal 75  at 17 MHz, unbalanced

Input Range Term: 0 to 12 dBnom due to cable loss at 17 MHz, from a nominal signal
PMP: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 12 dB due to cable
loss at 17 MHz, from a nominal signal

Transmitter
Table 123 lists specifications for the primary E3 transmitter.

Table 123 E3 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Output One BNC connector

Bit rate 34.368 Mbps

Line coding HDB3

Clock Source (Timing) – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
– Recovered from E3 Rx
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±100 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse Nominal 1.0 Vp Complies with ITU-T G.703 (11/01)

Impedance Nominal 75 

Level measurements
Table 124 lists frequency and level measurement specifications for E3.

Table 124 E3 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx Frequency Range: 34.368 MHz ±100 ppm


Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 179
Appendix A Specifications
Transport Module specifications

Table 124 E3 frequency and level measurement specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Level Vp Range: 1.6 V to 0.01 V


Resolution: 0.01 V
Accuracy: ±0.02 V ±10%

DS3 electrical specifications


Table 125 on page 180 through Table 127 on page 181 list specifications for DS3 receivers, trans-
mitters, and frequency and level measurements.

Receivers
Table 125 lists specifications for the primary and secondary DS3 receivers.

Table 125 DS3 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Input Two BNC connectors

Bit rate 44.736 Mbps

Impedance Nominal 75  at 22 MHz unbalanced

Input Range High/Low: 0 to 12 dB due to cable loss at 22 MHz, from a high signal
DSX/Monitor: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 9 dB due to cable
loss at 22MHz, from a high signal

Transmitter
Table 126 lists specifications for the primary DS3 transmitter.

Table 126 DS3 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Output One BNC connector

Bit rate 44.736 Mbps

Line coding B3ZS

Clock Source – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from DS3 Rx1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±100 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse (high) Nominal 1.15 Vp. Complies with ANSI T1.102-1993 and ITU-T G.703 (11/01) after
passing through 450 feet of RG59B/U cable.

Pulse (DSX) Nominal 0.6 Vp. Complies with ANSI T1.102-1993 and ITU-T G.703 (11/01).

Pulse (low) Nominal 0.35 Vp

Pulse shape With output terminated in 75  resistive load and DSX selected, the T-BERD ⁄ MTS
8000, 6000A, and 5800 meets ITU-T Recommendation G.703 (11/01) and ANSI
T1.102-1993

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
180 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Transport Module specifications

Table 126 DS3 transmitter specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Impedance Nominal 75 

Physical measurements
Table 127 lists frequency, level, and jitter measurement specifications for DS3.

Table 127 DS3 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx – Range: 44.736 MHz ±100 ppm


frequency – Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
– Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

Level Vp – Range: 1.6 V to 0.01 V


– Resolution: 0.01 V
– Accuracy: ±0.02 V ±10%

STS-1 electrical specifications


Table 128 on page 181 through Table 130 on page 182 list specifications for STS-1 receivers, trans-
mitters, and frequency and level measurements.

Receivers
Table 128 lists specifications for the primary and secondary STS-1 receivers.

Table 128 STS-1 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Input Two BNC connectors

Bit rate 51.84 Mbps

Impedance Nominal 75  at 26 MHz unbalanced

Range – High/Low: 0 to 12 dB due to cable loss at 26 MHz, from a high signal


– DSX/Monitor: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 9 dB due
to cable loss at 26 MHz, from a high signal

Transmitter
Table 129 lists specifications for the primary STS-1 transmitter.

Table 129 STS-1 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Output One BNC connector

Bit rate 51.84 Mbps

Line coding B3ZS

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 181
Appendix A Specifications
Transport Module specifications

Table 129 STS-1 transmitter specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Clock Source – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from STS-1 Rx1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±50 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse (high) Nominal 1.15 Vp. Complies with ANSI T1.102-1993 and ITU-T G.703 (11/
01) after passing through 450 feet of RG59B/U cable.

Pulse (DSX) Nominal 0.6 Vp. Complies with ANSI T1.102-1993 and ITU-T G.703 (11/01).

Pulse (low) Nominal 0.32 Vp

Pulse shape With output terminated in 75  resistive load and DSX selected, the Dual
Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM meets ITU-T Recommenda-
tion G.703 (11/01) and ANSI T1.102-1993

Impedance Nominal 75 

Physical measurements
Table 130 lists frequency and level measurement specifications for STS-1.

Table 130 STS-1 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx frequency Range: 51.84 MHz ±50 ppm


Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

Level Vp Range: 1.6 V to 0.01 V


Resolution: 0.01 V
Accuracy: ±0.02 V ±10%

E4 electrical specifications
Table 131 on page 182 through Table 133 on page 183 list specifications for E4 receivers, transmit-
ters, and frequency and level measurements.

Receiver
Table 131 lists specifications for the E4 receiver.

Table 131 E4 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Input One BNC connector

Bit rate 139.264 Mbps

Impedance Nominal 75  at 70 MHz unbalanced

Range – Term: 0 to 12 dB due to cable loss at 70 MHz, from a nominal signal


– PMP: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 12 dB due to cable
loss at 70 MHz, from a nominal signal

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
182 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Transport Module specifications

Transmitter
Table 132 lists specifications for the primary E4 transmitter.

Table 132 E4 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Output One BNC connector

Bit rate 139.264 Mbps

Line coding CMI


Tx clock – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from E4 Rx
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±50 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse Nominal 1.0 Vpp Complies with ITU-T G.703 (11/01)

Impedance Nominal 75 

Physical measurements
Table 133 lists frequency and level measurement specifications for E4.

Table 133 E4 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx Frequency – Range: 139.264 MHz ±100 ppm


– Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
– Resolution: 1 Hz, or 1 ppm

Level Vpp – Range: 1.2 V to 0.01 V


– Resolution: 0.01 V
– Accuracy: ±0.02 V ±10%

STM-1 electrical specifications


Table 134 on page 183 through Table 136 on page 184 list specifications for STM-1 receivers,
transmitters, and frequency and level measurements.

Receiver
Table 134 lists specifications for the STM-1 receiver.

Table 134 STM-1 receiver specifications


Parameter Specification

Input One BNC connector

Bit rate 155.52 Mbps

Impedance Nominal 75  at 78 MHz unbalanced

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 183
Appendix A Specifications
Transport Module specifications

Table 134 STM-1 receiver specifications (Continued)


Parameter Specification

Range Term: 0 to 12.7 dB due to cable loss at 78 MHz, from a nominal signal
PMP: -20 dB due to resistive loss in addition to 0 to 12.7 dB due to cable loss
at 78 MHz, from a nominal signal

Transmitter
Table 135 lists specifications for the STM-1 transmitter.

Table 135 STM-1 transmitter specifications


Parameter Specification

Output One BNC connector

Bit rate 155.52 Mbps

Line coding CMI


Tx clock – Internal reference clock with accuracy ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
(Timing) – Recovered from Rx1
– External from BITS, SETS, or CLOCK

Frequency offset ±50 ppm, in 1 ppm steps

Pulse Nominal 1.0 Vpp Complies with ITU-T G.703 (11/01)

Impedance Nominal 75 

Physical measurements
Table 136 lists frequency and level measurement specifications for STM-1.

Table 136 STM-1 frequency and level measurement specifications


Parameter Specification

Tx and Rx – Range: 155.52 MHz ±50 ppm


Frequency – Accuracy: ±1.5 ppm, ±1 ppm per year aging
– Resolution: 1 Hz or 1 ppm

Level Vpp – Range: 1.2 V to 0.01 V


– Resolution: 0.01 V
– Accuracy: ±0.02 V ±10%

10/100/1000Base T electrical specifications


The Transport Module provides up to two connectors with interfaces that support rates of 10Base-
T, 100Base-T, and 1000Base-T. Each connector is fully compliant with IEEE 802.3, IEEE 802.3u,
and IEEE 802.3ab.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
184 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Transport Module specifications

Optical specifications
Table 137 provides the SONET, SDH, and Ethernet optical rates supported by the Dual Module
Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM.

Table 137 SONET, SDH, Ethernet, and OTN rates


Rate SONET SDH OTN Ethernet Fibre Channel

100 Gbps N/A N/A 111.8 Gbps 100GigE N/A

40 Gbps N/A N/A 43.02 Gbps 40 GigE N/A

10 Gbps OC-192 STM-64 10.7 Gbps 10GigE 10Gig


11.1 Gbps
11.05 Gbps

8 Gbps N/A N/A N/A N/A 8Gig

4 Gbps N/A N/A N/A N/A 4Gig

2.5 Gbps OC-48 STM-16 2.7 Gbps N/A N/A

2 Gbps N/A N/A N/A N/A 2Gig

1 Gbps N/A N/A N/A 1 GigE 1Gig

622 Mbps OC-12 STM-4 N/A N/A N/A

155 Mbps OC-3 STM-1 N/A N/A N/A

100 Mbps N/A N/A N/A 100M N/A

Interface specifications- Jitter and Wander applications


The electrical and optical interface specifications for the Transport Module Jitter and Wander appli-
cations are detailed in “Jitter and Wander specifications” on page 187.

Interface specifications- Non-Jitter and Wander applications


Table 138 describes the optical interface specifications for the internal SONET, SDH, and Ethernet
optical connectors for non-jitter and wander applications.

If your unit is equipped with SFP interfaces, the interfaces comply with INF-8074i, Rev 1.0 published
on May 12, 2001. For SFP specifications refer to the specifications provided by the manufacturer.

Table 138 Optical interface specifications (Non-Jitter/Wander)


Item Description

Optical connector types1 FC, SC, ST, or LC

Wavelength 850, 1310, or 1550 nm

Fiber mode compatibility 1310 and 1550 nm — singlemode fiber


850 nm — multimode fiber

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 185
Appendix A Specifications
Transport Module specifications

Table 138 Optical interface specifications (Non-Jitter/Wander) (Continued)


Item Description

Transmit level
1550 nm, 2.5 Gbps and lower 0 to -6.5 dBm
1310 nm, 2.5 Gbps option +3 to -3.5 dBm
1310 nm, 622 Mbps option -8 to -16.5 dBm
1310 nm, 1 GigE option -3 to -13 dBm
850 nm, 1 GigE option -3 to -13 dBm

Transmit level for 10Gbps


1550 nm +4 to -3 dBm
1310 nm -1 to -7 dBm
850 nm Per IEEE std 802.3ae 2002 for 10GigE

Eye diagram, 1310 nm, 1550 nm Per Telcordia GR-253-CORE Issue 4-2005
ITU-T REC. G.957
Per IEEE std 802.3ae 2002
850 nm, 1310 nm
Clock frequency accuracy ±1.5 ppm ±1 ppm per year aging

Receive level range


2.5 Gbps option - 9 to -27 dBm
155 Mbps option - 8 to -34 dBm
622 Mbps option - 8 to -28 dBm
GigE only ports
1310 nm -3 to -19 dBm
850 nm 0 to -17 dBm

Receive level range 10 Gbps


1310 nm only option -1 to -11 dBm
1550 nm intermediate reach (IR) option -1 to -14 dBm
1550 nm long reach (LR) option
-9 to -23 at 9.95 Gbps
850 nm -9 to -22 at 11.1 Gbps
-1 to -11 dBm

Transmitter frequency offset ±50 ppm from the nominal rate, in 1 ppm steps

Frequency measurement accuracy ±1.5 ppm ±1 ppm per year aging

Jitter output Per Telcordia GR-253-CORE Issue 4-2005


ITU-T G.825, IEEE std 802.3ae 2002

Receiver shutdown2
2.5 Gbps option -5.9 dBm
10 Gbps long reach -5.9 dBm

Reflectance Per Telcordia GR-253-CORE Issue 4-2005


Level measurement range
2.5 Gbps - 6 to -30 dBm
622 Mbps -5 to -31 dBm
155 Mbps -5 to -31 dBm

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
186 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Jitter and Wander specifications

Table 138 Optical interface specifications (Non-Jitter/Wander) (Continued)


Item Description

Level measurement range for 10 Gbps


1310 nm and 1550 nm
IR RX +0 to -17 dBm
LR RX -6 to -20 dBm
850 nm +0 to -14 dbm

Level measurement accuracy ±3 dB

Level measurement resolution 0.1dB

APS
resolution 1ms
accuracy 1ms

RTD
resolution 1 s
accuracy 2 s

1. Remove the connector to clean the optical fiber.


2. Do not apply a greater than –8 dBm optical-level signal to the long reach receiver on the Dual Module Carrier,
Transport Module, and MSAM. Damage to the receiver may occur.

Jitter and Wander specifications


Refer to the following sections for jitter and wander specifications for theT-BERD / MTS 5800,
Transport Module, and MSAM:

– “Electrical jitter and wander specifications” on page 187


– “Interface specifications (Jitter and Wander applications)” on page 193
– “Optical jitter and wander specifications” on page 194

Electrical jitter and wander specifications


This section provides electrical jitter and wander specifications for the T-BERD / MTS 5800, Trans-
port Module, and MSAM. For specifications, see:

– “Standards” on page 187


– “Jitter generator” on page 188
– “Jitter analyzer” on page 188
– “Automatic jitter measurements” on page 190
– “Wander generator” on page 191
– “Wander measurement” on page 191
– “Memory requirements” on page 192

Standards
Jitter and wander are generated and analyzed in accordance with the following standards:

– ITU-T Recommendations G.823, G.825, O.172 (04/2005)

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 187
Appendix A Specifications
Jitter and Wander specifications

– Telcordia GR-499-CORE Issue 2-1998, GR-253-CORE Issue 4-2005


– ANSI Standards T1.102 - 1993, Table 9, T1.404-1994 section 5.10

Jitter generator
Meets or exceeds the requirements stated in ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/2005).

Modulation specifications
Table 139 provides modulation specifications for the electrical jitter generator.

Table 139 Electrical jitter generator modulation specifications


Item Description

Jitter modulation signal Sine wave

Jitter amplitude Per ITU-T O.172

Step width 0.001 UI

Modulation frequency accuracy ± 0.1%

The settling time for the changes in amplitude is less than 30 seconds.

Error limits
Error limits conform to the requirements stated in ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/2005).

Intrinsic jitter
The maximum output jitter of the Transport Module (intrinsic jitter) for a jitter amplitude setting of 0
UI is < 0.04 UIpp. Wideband is assumed.

Jitter analyzer
Meets or exceeds the requirements of ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/2005).

Bit rate
Table 140 describes the bit rate specifications for the electrical jitter analyzer.

Table 140 Bit rate of the electrical jitter analyzer


Item Description

Bit rate 1.544 Mbps, 44.736 Mbps, 2.048 Mbps, 34.368 Mbps, 51.84 Mbps,
139.264 Mbps, 155.520 Mbps

Permitted offset ± 1000 ppm

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
188 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Jitter and Wander specifications

Measuring ranges
Table 141 provides measuring ranges for the electrical jitter analyzer.

Table 141 Electrical jitter analyzer measuring ranges


Item Range/Resolution

Peak-Peak 0 to 4,000 UIpp/1 mUIpp


RMS 0 to 2,000 UI/1 mUI

Measurement filters - Standard range


Table 142 describes the standard range and properties for the measurement filters. The default filter
settings are per ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/2005).

Table 142 Standard ranges and properties for the measurement filters
Item Description

High-pass filters1 2 Hz, 4 Hz, 10 Hz, 20Hz, 40 Hz, 80 Hz, 100Hz, 200Hz, 400 Hz,
500 Hz, 700 Hz, 1 kHz, 3 kHz, 5 kHz, 8 kHz, 10 kHz, 12 kHz,
18 kHz, 20 kHz, 30 kHz, 65 kHz, 80 kHz, 250 kHz

High-pass filter characteristics 1st order (to ITU-T O.172)

Low-pass filter 40 kHz, 60 kHz, 100 kHz, 400 kHz, 800 kHz, 1.3 MHz, 3.5 MHz

Low-pass filter characteristics 3rd order Butterworth


(refer to ITU-T O.172)

Filter properties:
-3 dB cut-off frequency tolerance fc ± 10%

Maximum attenuation at least 60 dB/decade

1. Filter availability depends on the electrical input rate.

Results display
Positive and negative jitter amplitudes are measured.

Current values
Table 143 describes the ranges for the current values. The values are displayed continuously, or
they appear in a graph.

Table 143 Ranges for the current values


Item Description

Standard range
– Jitter peak-peak – 4000 UIpp
– Jitter +peak/-peak – 2000 UIp

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 189
Appendix A Specifications
Jitter and Wander specifications

Display resolution
Table 144 describes the resolution of the current and maximum values for displayed and logged
results.

Table 144 Display resolution for the maximum values


Item Description

Standard range 0.001 UIpp

Error limits for displayed jitter


The error limits for displayed jitter meet the requirements of ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/
2005).

The stated error limits apply under the following conditions:

– Sine wave modulation


– Structured test signals (for STM-1e as described in ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/2005))
– Standard filter selections

RMS jitter - Range and resolution


Refer to Table 141 on page 189 for the RMS range and resolution. Measurement accuracy is per
ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/2005).

Automatic jitter measurements


This section provides specifications for automatic jitter measurements.

Maximum Tolerable Jitter (MTJ)


A group of up to 20 user-specified jitter frequencies (scan frequencies) can be defined. A set of pre-
defined masks per applicable standards is also provided.

Fast Maximum Tolerable Jitter (Fast MTJ)


A group of up to 20 user-specified frequencies (scan frequencies) can be defined. A set of pre-
defined masks per applicable standards is also provided.

Jitter Transfer Function (JTF) measurement


A group of up to 20 user-specified jitter frequencies (scan frequencies) can be defined. A set of pre-
defined masks per applicable standards is also provided.

Table 145 describes the JTF measurement specifications.

Table 145 JTF measurement specifications


Item Description

Settling time 0.1 to 999.9 seconds

RMS integration period 5 seconds

Recovery time 0.1 to 999.9 seconds

Filter bandwidth 10 Hz
(band-pass, -3 dB)

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
190 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Jitter and Wander specifications

Table 145 JTF measurement specifications (Continued)


Item Description

Measurement range -60 dB to -50 dB

Measurement error
According to ITU-T Recommendations G.783 and G.8251.

Wander generator
This section provides specifications for the electrical wander generator (only available on the 40G/
100G Transport Module).

Bit rate
Table 146 provides bit rate specifications for the electrical wander generator.

Table 146 Bit rate specifications


Item Description

Bit rate 1.544 Mbps, 44.736 Mbps, 2.048 Mbps, 34.368 Mbps, 51.89 Mbps,
139.264 Mbps, 155.520 Mbps

Maximum offset ± 50 ppm

Modulation source internal

Modulation specifications
Table 147 describes the modulation specifications for the electrical wander generator.

Table 147 Modulation specifications


Item Description

Jitter modulation signal sinusoidal

Frequency range 10 Hz to 100 MHz

Amplitude range at 155.52 Mbps 0.01 UI to 3600 UI

Error limits
The error limits conform to the requirements of ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/2005), with a
modulation frequency accuracy of ± 0.1%.

Synchronization
When generating wander, the Transport Module must be synchronized with an external timing
source. For more details, see “Reference clock” on page 192.

Wander measurement
This section provides specifications for wander measurements.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 191
Appendix A Specifications
Jitter and Wander specifications

Reference clock
Table 148 lists the wander clock frequency and input level specifications.l

Table 148 Wander clock frequency and input level specifications


Permissible offset ± 1000 ppm

Wander transfer bandwidth Driven by the low pass filter as specified in Table 149 on page 192.

Measurement range
The upper limit of the wander frequency range is set by a first-order low-pass filter. The sample rate
is selected automatically to correspond with the selected low-pass filter. Table 149 lists the sample
rates for various low pass filters.

Table 149 Sample rates for various low pass filters


Low pass filter/fc Sample rate

0.1 Hz 1/s
10 Hz 30/s

20 Hz 60/s

100 Hz 1000/s

Measurement filters
Measurement filters are defined per ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/2005).

Memory requirements
Table 150 describes the memory requirements (storage requirements) for the base unit when
measuring wander.

Table 150 Memory requirements for wander measurements


Sample rate Required flash/hard disk space

1/second approximately 150 KB/hour

30/second approximately 5 MB/hour

60/second approximately 9.0 MB/hour

1000/second1 approximately 150 MB/hour

1. Supported on 40G/100G Transport Module and MSAM only.

The maximum wander measurement time is only limited by the available hard disk space. However,
you can only perform wander analysis (MTIE/TDEV) for the first 8.64 million samples of the
measurement.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
192 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Jitter and Wander specifications

Interface specifications (Jitter and Wander applications)


Table 151 describes the specifications for the optical connectors when running jitter and wander
applications. The interfaces meet the specifications stated in ITU-T Recommendation G.957/
GR-253.

Table 151 Optical interface specifications (Jitter and Wander applications)


Item Description

Optical connector types1 FC, SC, ST, or LC

Wavelength 1310 and 1550 nm

Line rates – 155 Mbps


– 622 Mbps
– 2488 Mbps
– 2666 Mbps

Line code Scrambled NRZ

Transmitter specifications

Transmit level -2 to +3 dBm

Fiber mode compatibility 1310 and 1550 nm — singlemode fiber

Frequency offset +50 ppm from the nominal rate,


in 1 ppm steps

Frequency accuracy +1,5 ppm +1 ppm per year aging

Synchronization See the Reference Clock Requirements published in the testing


guide that shipped with your unit.

Receiver specifications

Wavelength range 1260 to 1360 nm


1430 to 1580 nm

Rx offset acceptance +100 ppm


Sensitivity 622/2488/2666 Mbps
– -8 to -28 dBm
155 Mbps
– -8 to -34 dBm

Maximum input power (destructive) +0 dBm

Fiber mode compatibility OC3/OC12 connector


– multimode fiber
– singlemode fiber
OC48/OTU1 connector
– singlemode fiber

Optical level measurement 622/2488/2666 Mbps


– -8 to -28 dBm
155 Mbps
– -8 to -34 dBm

Level measurement accuracy +3 dB


Level measurement resolution 0.1 dB

1. Remove the connector to clean the optical fiber.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 193
Appendix A Specifications
Jitter and Wander specifications

Optical jitter and wander specifications


This section provides jitter and wander specifications for the Transport Module and MSAM. For
specifications, see:

– “Standards” on page 194


– “Jitter generator” on page 194
– “Jitter analyzer” on page 195
– “Automatic jitter measurements” on page 197
– “Wander generator” on page 198
– “Wander measurement” on page 199
– “Memory requirements” on page 200

Standards
Optical jitter and wander are generated and analyzed in accordance with the following standards:

– ITU-T Recommendations G.825, G.8251, O.172 (04/2005) and O.173 (03/2003)


– Telcordia GR-253-CORE Issue 4-2005
– ANSI Standards T1.101, T1.105.03

Jitter generator
The jitter generator meets or exceeds the requirements of ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/2005)
and O.173 (03/2003).

Internal modulation source


Table 152 provides modulation specifications for the optical jitter generator.

Table 152 Modulation specifications


Item Optical

Jitter modulation signal Sine wave

Jitter amplitude up to 800 UIpp

Step size 0.001 UI

The settling time for the changes in amplitude is less than two seconds.

Error limits
Error limits conform to the requirements of ITU-T Recommendations O.172 (04/2005) and O.173
(03/2003).

Intrinsic jitter
The maximum output jitter of the Transport Module (intrinsic jitter) for a jitter amplitude setting of 0
UI is < 0.04 UIpp. Wideband is assumed.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
194 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Jitter and Wander specifications

Jitter analyzer
Meets or exceeds the requirements of ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/2005) and O.173 (03/
2003).

Measuring ranges
Table 153 describes the measuring ranges for the optical jitter analyzer.

Table 153 Measuring ranges


Item Range/Resolution

Standard
– Peak-Peak 0 to 50 UIpp/1 mUIpp
– RMS 0 to 25 UI/0.1 mUI

Extended
– Peak-Peak
155M 0 to 50 UIpp/100 mUIpp
622M 0 to 200 UIpp/100 mUIpp
2.5/2.7G 0 to 800 UIpp/100 mUIpp
– RMS
155M 0 to 25 UI/10 mUI
622M 0 to 100 UI/10 mUI
2.5/2.7G 0 to 400 UI/10 mUI

Measurement filters
This section provides specifications for the measurement filters.

Standard range
Table 154 describes the standard range and properties for the measurement filters.

Table 154 Standard ranges and properties for the measurement filters
Item Description

High-pass filters 500 Hz, 1 kHz, 5 kHz, 12 kHz, 65 kHz, 250 kHz, 1 MHz

High-pass filter characteristics 1st order (to ITU-T O.172/O.173)


Low-pass filter 1.3 MHz, 5 MHz, 20 MHz

Low-pass filter characteristics 3rd order Butterworth


(to ITU-T O.172/O.173)

Filter properties:
-3 dB cut-off frequency toler- fc ± 10%
ance

Maximum attenuation at least 60 dB

Default filter settings are per ITU-T Recommendations O.172 (04/2005) and O.173 (03/2003).

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 195
Appendix A Specifications
Jitter and Wander specifications

Extended range
Table 155 provides the extended range for the measurement filters.

Table 155 Extended ranges for measurement filters


Item Description

High-pass filter characteristics typically 25 Hz


(-3 dB cut-off frequency)

Low-pass filter typically 400 kHz

Results display
Positive and negative jitter amplitudes are measured.

Current and maximum values


The current and maximum values are displayed continuously or shown as a graph. Table 156
describes the ranges for the current and maximum values.

Table 156 Ranges for the current and maximum values


Item Description

Standard range
– Jitter peak-peak – 50 UIpp
– Jitter +peak/-peak – 25 UIp

Extended range
– Jitter peak-peak – 800 UIpp
– Jitter +peak/-peak – 400 UIp

Resolution
Table 157 describes the resolution for the current and maximum values, display and logged results.

Table 157 Resolution for current and maximum values


Item Description

Standard range 0.001 UIpp

Extended range 0.1 UIpp

Error limits for jitter measurement


The error limits for displayed jitter meet the requirements of ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/
2005) and O.173 (03/2003).

The stated error limits apply under the following conditions:

– Optical input level in the range -10 dBm to -12 dBm (scrambled NRZ signal code)
– Structured test signals (for SDH as described in ITU-T Recommendation O.172)
– Sine wave modulation
– Standard filters: Highband

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
196 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Jitter and Wander specifications

Measurement error
The stated measurement error applies without restriction to standard range, for values >25 UIp in
extended range.

– Maximum measurement error: ± R % of reading ± W


The value for W (fixed error) is taken from Table 158. The value for R (variable error) can be taken
from ITU-T Recommendations O.172 (04/2005) and O.173 (03/2003) as applicable.

Table 158 W (fixed error)


Range Wide-band Filter Extended-band Filter

W in UIpp W in UIpp

Standard range 0.0351 0.5

1. Mapping SDH VC-4/SONET STS-1, payload pattern PRBS31, environmental temperature +20C to +30C.

RMS jitter
This section describes the RMS jitter specifications.

Range and resolution


Table 159 describes the RMS range and resolution.

Table 159 RMS range and resolution


(peak-peak) Standard range Extended range

RMS range 0 to 25 UI 0 to 400 UI

Resolution 0.0001 UI 0.01 UI

Measurement accuracy
Table 160 describes the RMS jitter measurement accuracy.

Table 160 RMS jitter measurement accuracy


Item Description

Standard range ± R% of measured value ± 0.003 UI1

Extended range ± R% of measured value ± 0.05 UI1

Integration time 1 second

1. The value R (variable error) is taken from ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/2005) and O.173 (03/2003) as applica-
ble.

Automatic jitter measurements


This section provides specifications for automatic jitter measurements.

Maximum Tolerable Jitter (MTJ)


A group of up to 20 user-specified jitter frequencies (scan frequencies) can be defined. A set of pre-
defined masks per applicable standards is also provided.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 197
Appendix A Specifications
Jitter and Wander specifications

Fast Maximum Tolerable Jitter (Fast MTJ)


A group of up 20 user-specified frequencies (scan frequencies) can be defined. A set of pre-defined
masks per applicable standards is also provided.

Jitter Transfer Function (JTF) measurement


A group of up to 20 user-specified jitter frequencies (scan frequencies) can be defined. A set of pre-
defined masks per applicable standards is also provided.

Table 161 describes the JTF measurement specifications.

Table 161 JTF measurement specifications


Item Description

TX jitter settings see Table 139 on page 188

Settling time 0.1 to 999.9 seconds

RMS integration period 5 seconds

Recovery time 0.1 to 999.9 seconds

Filter bandwidth 10 Hz
(band-pass, -3 dB)

Measurement error
Per ITU-T Recommendations G.783 and G.8251.

Wander generator
This section provides specifications for the optical wander generator.

Modulation
Table 162 provides the modulation specifications for the optical wander generator.

Table 162 Internal modulation source specifications


Item Description

Jitter modulation signal sinusoidal

Frequency range 10 Hz to 10 Hz

Amplitude range at 2.5/2.7G 0.1 UI to 100000UI

Modulation frequency accuracy ± 0.1%

Error limits
The error limits conform to the requirements of ITU-T Recommendations O.172 (04/2005) and
O.173 (03/2003).

Synchronization
When generating wander, the Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM must be synchro-
nized to an external timing source. For more details, see “Reference clock” on page 192.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
198 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Jitter and Wander specifications

Wander measurement
This section provides specifications when measuring wander on an optical circuit.

Reference clock
See to “Reference clock” on page 192 for reference clock requirements.

Table 163 Wander clock frequency specifications


Item Description

Permissible offset + 20 ppm

Wander transfer bandwidth approximately 1 Hz

TIE measurement
Per ITU-T Recommendation O.172 (04/2005) and O.173 (03/2003), TIE can be interpreted as the
time difference between the signal you are measuring and the reference clock. This measurement
is used to calculate other results, such as MTIE and TDEV. To ensure accuracy of the TIE measure-
ment, warm-up the Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM for at least 30 minutes and
ensure there is no change in ambient temperature exceeding 5 Celsius.

Measurement range
The upper limit of the wander frequency range is set by a first-order low-pass filter. The sample rate
is selected automatically to correspond with the selected low-pass filter. Table 164 lists the sample
rates for various low pass filters.

Table 164 Wander clock frequency specifications


Maximum measurable rate of
Low pass filter/fc Sample rate
phase change at 2.5/2.7G

0.1 Hz 1/s 250000 UI/s

10 Hz 30/s 250000 UI/s

20 Hz 60/s 250000 UI/s

100 Hz 1000/s 300000 UI/s

Measurement filters
This section provides specifications for the measurement filters.

Table 165 describes the measurement filters.

Table 165 Measurement filters


Item Description

Low-pass filter 0.1, 10, 20, 100 Hz

Low-pass filter characteristics 1st order (to ITU-T O.172/O.173)


Filter properties:
-3 dB cut-off frequency tolerance fc ± 10%
Pass band ripple (referred to 0.1 Hz) < + 0.2 dB
Maximum attenuation > 30 dB

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 199
Appendix A Specifications
40G/100G Transport Module specifications

Default filter settings are per ITU-T Recommendations O.172 (04/2005) and O.173 (03/2003).

Memory requirements
See “Memory requirements” on page 192.

40G/100G Transport Module specifications


Refer to the following sections for specifications for the 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module:

– “Physical Specifications” on page 200


– “Power Supply Specifications” on page 200
– “Battery Specifications” on page 200
– “Optical Specifications” on page 201

Physical Specifications
The physical characteristics for the 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module are identical to those
detailed in Table 111 on page 174 and Table 112 on page 174.

Power Supply Specifications


The specifications for the Power Supply for the 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module are
detailed in Table 166.

Table 166 Power Supply Specifications


Item 220W power supply

Input, nominal range 100-240 V. 50-60 Hz, 0.4A

Output 20 V, 11A, 220W max power

Battery Specifications
To ensure the maximum operating time is obtained while testing using the 40G/100G High Speed
Transport Module, if you are not using the power adapter, be certain to install two batteries in the
battery module. Different tests deplete the batteries at different rates; therefore battery life can not
be guaranteed for any specific length of time. Always use the power supply when multiple modules
are attached.

The specifications for the battery contained within the 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module are
detailed in Table 167.

Table 167 Battery Specifications


Item Specification

Battery Life 30 minutes minimum


(40G/100G High Speed Transport Module only)

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
200 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
CSAM specifications

Optical Specifications
The 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module has two optical module interfaces - the 40/100G CFP
and the 40G QSFP+.

CFP Interface
The optical specifications for the CFP module interface in the 40G/100G High Speed Transport
Module are detailed in Table 168.

Table 168 CFP Optical Module Interface Specifications


Module Specification

CFP, hot-pluggable compliant with CFP MSA, IEEE 802.3ba

QSFP+ Interface
The optical specifications for the QSFP+ interface in the 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module
are detailed in Table 169.

Table 169 QSFP+ Optical Module Interface Specifications


Module Specification

QSFP+, hot-pluggable compliant with QSFP+ MSA(SFF-8436), IEEE P802.3ba

CSAM specifications
Refer to the following sections for specifications for the 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module:

– “Physical Specifications” on page 200


– “Power Supply Specifications” on page 200
– “Battery Specifications” on page 200
– “Optical Specifications” on page 201

Physical Specifications
The physical characteristics for the 40G/100G High Speed Transport Module are identical to those
detailed in Table 170.

Table 170 CSAM physical specifications


Item Description

Height 1.25 inches / 3.17 cm

Width 4.87 inches / 12.38 cm

Depth 9.12 inches / 23.49 cm

Weight (CSAM only) 1.0 lbs / 0.45 kg


Combined Weight (CSAM, 6000Av2 Base Unit, 7.6 lbs / 3.4 kg
one CFP2)

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 201
Appendix A Specifications
CSAM specifications

Power Supply Specifications


The specifications for the Power Supply for CSAM are detailed in Table 171 and Table 172.

Table 171 CSAM in 6000Av2


Item 220W power supply

Input, nominal range 100-240 V. 50-60 Hz, 2A

Maximum power draw 150W

Table 172 CSAM in 8000v2


Item 220W power supply

Input, nominal range 100-240 V. 50-60 Hz, 0.4A

Output 20 V, 11A, 220W max power

Battery Specifications
To ensure the maximum operating time is obtained while testing using the CSAM, if you are not
using the power adapter, be certain to install two batteries in the 6000Av2 or 8000v2. Different tests
deplete the batteries at different rates; therefore battery life can not be guaranteed for any specific
length of time. Always use the power supply when multiple modules are attached to an 8000v2.

The specifications for the battery contained used by the CSAM are detailed in Table 167.

Table 173 Battery Specifications


Item Specification

Battery Life in 6000Av2 45 minutes minimum

Battery Life in 8000Av2 1 hour 30 minutes minimum


(one CSAM in DMCv2)

Optical Specifications
The CSAM has three physical optical ports — CFP2, QSFP+, and SFP+.

CFP2 Interface
The optical specifications for the CFP2 module interface in the CSAM are detailed in Table 174.

Table 174 CFP Optical Module Interface Specifications


Module Specification

CFP2, hot-pluggable compliant with CFP MSA, CFP2 Hardware Specification Rev 1.0, E
802.3ba

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
202 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
DMC specifications

QSFP+ Interface
The optical specifications for the QSFP+ interface in the CSAM are detailed in Table 175.

Table 175 QSFP+ Optical Module Interface Specifications


Module Specification

QSFP+, hot-pluggable compliant with QSFP+ MSA(SFF-8436), IEEE P802.3ba

SFP+ Interface
The optical specifications for the SFP+ interface in the CSAM are detailed in Table 176.

Table 176 QSFP+ Optical Module Interface Specifications


Module Specification

SFP/SFP+, hot-pluggable compliant with MSA(SFF-8436), IEEE P802.3ba

DMC specifications
Refer to the following sections for specifications for the DMC:

– “Physical specifications” on page 203


– “Power supply specifications” on page 204
– “Battery specifications” on page 204

Physical specifications
The physical characteristics for the DMC are described in Table 177.

Table 177 Module physical specifications


Item Description

Height 2.75 inches / 7 cm

Width 12 inches / 30.48 cm

Depth 9.74 inches / 24.76 cm

Weight DMC Only:


– 4.91 lbs / 2.22 kg
Combined (DMC, two MSAMs, 8000 base unit, two SFP PIMs, and two XFP PIMs):
– 17.28 lbs / 7.83 kg

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 203
Appendix A Specifications
Transceiver specifications

Power supply specifications


Table 178 describes the specifications for the 150W power supply.

Table 178 Power supply specifications


Item 150W power supply

Input, nominal range 100-240 V. 50-60 Hz, 2A

Maximum power draw 150 watts

Battery specifications
To ensure the maximum operating time is obtained while testing using the DMC and MSAMs, if you
are not using the power adapter, be certain to install two batteries in the battery module. Different
tests deplete the batteries at different rates; therefore, when performing more than one BER test,
battery life can not be guaranteed for any specific length of time. Do not power the unit using
batteries if multiple DMCs or application modules are attached.

For detailed battery information, refer to the 8000 Base Unit User Manual.

Transceiver specifications
For detailed transceiver specifications, refer to your SFP, SFP+, XFP, QSFP+ or CFP manufac-
turer’s web site. Summarized information for inserted transceivers (such as the model number,
supported wavelength, and supported interface) is provided on the user interface (GUI).

If you are not certain whether you are using a JDSU recommended transceiver, contact your local
JDSU representative, or review the list of JDSU Recommended Optics that shipped with the trans-
ceiver.

Environmental specifications
Refer to the following sections for environmental specifications for the MSAM and the Transport
Module.

– “T-BERD / MTS 5800 Environmental specifications” on page 205


– “MSAM Environmental Specifications” on page 205
– “Transport Module Environmental Specifications” on page 206

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
204 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix A Specifications
Environmental specifications

T-BERD / MTS 5800 Environmental specifications


Table 179 lists the environmental characteristics for the T-BERD / MTS 5800. Operating tempera-
ture and humidity are provided below; for storage temperature and humidity, see “Storing the instru-
ment” on page 208.

Table 179 T-BERD / MTS 5800 Environmental specifications


Item Description

Operating Temperature 32F to 122F (0C to +50C)


Note: For maximum battery capacity and runtime, limit charge and dis-
charge temperature of the battery to 40°C (104F).

Operating Humidity 10% to 90% relative humidity, non-condensing

Shock/Drop/Vibe Shock - per IEC 68-2-27 and 68-2-29 Ed. 2.0


Drop - per IEC 721-3-7 2nd Ed. /IEC 61010-1
Vibration - per IEC 68-2-6 and MIL-PRF-28800F (Class 2)

MSAM Environmental Specifications


Table 180 lists the environmental characteristics for the assembled instrument. Operating temper-
ature and humidity are provided below; for storage temperature and humidity, see “Storing the
instrument” on page 208.

Table 180 MSAM Environmental specifications


Item Model Description

Operating Temperature MSAMv2 All applications


32F to 104F (0C to +40C)

MSAM v1 One or two applications at line rates less than 10 Gbps:


– 32F to 104F (0C to +40C)

One 10 Gbps application, with a second application at a line


rate less than 10 Gbps:
– 32°F to 95°F (0°C to +35°C)

OTU-1 applications
– 32F to 104F (0C to +40C)
OTU-2 applications
– 32°F to 95°F (0°C to +35°C)

Operating Humidity 5% to 95% relative humidity, non-condensing

Shock/drop height As published in the 6000A Base Unit User Manual

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 205
Appendix A Specifications
Environmental specifications

Transport Module Environmental Specifications


Table 181 lists the environmental characteristics for the assembled instrument. Operating temper-
ature and humidity are provided below; for storage temperature and humidity, see “Storing the
instrument” on page 208.

Table 181 Transport Module Environmental Specifications


Item Description

Operating Temperature 32F to 104F (0C to +40C)

Operating Humidity 5% to 95% relative humidity, non-condensing

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
206 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
B
Appendix B Storage and Shipment

This appendix describes how to maintain, store and ship your test instrument. Topics discussed in
this appendix include the following:

– “Storing the instrument” on page 208


– “Shipping the your instrument” on page 209
– “Returning equipment to JDSU” on page 209

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 207
Appendix B Storage and Shipment
Storing the instrument

Storing the instrument


When the instrument is not in use, it can be stored. You should follow the criteria below when storing
the Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM.

Environmental specifications
TheT-BERD/MTS 5800, Transport Module and DMC should be stored according to the environ-
mental specifications listed in Table 182.

Table 182 T-BERD/MTS 5800, Transport Module and DMC storage specifications
Item Description

Storage Temperature -4F to 140F (-20C to +60C)

Humidity at 86F (30C) 10% to 95% relative humidity, non-condensing

Shock/drop height (non-operating) Meets requirements specified in IEC 721-3-7, 2nd Ed. for Class
7M3 products.

The T-BERD/MTS 5800 should be stored according to the environmental specifications listed in
Table 182.

Table 183 Transport Module and DMC storage specifications


Item Description

Storage Temperature -4F to 140F (-20C to +60C)

Humidity at 86F (30C) 10% to 95% relative humidity, non-condensing

Shock/drop height (non-operating) Meets requirements specified in IEC 721-3-7, 2nd Ed. for Class
7M3 products.

The MSAM and PIMs should be stored according to the environmental specifications listed in
Table 184.

Table 184 Environmental specifications for storage


Item Description

Storage Temperature -4F to 140F (-20C to +60C)

Humidity at 86F (30C) 10% to 95% relative humidity, non-condensing

Shock/drop height (non-operating) As published in the 6000A Base Unit User Manual.

Other environmental limitations


The battery discharges slowly while in the instrument. Continued storage while in a discharged state
could result in performance degradation. For this reason, JDSU recommends removing the battery
from the base unit, if the instrument will not be used for more than a week. Store the battery in a
cool, dry, clean environment. Do not leave the battery in a car or truck, particularly during extremely
warm weather.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
208 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix B Storage and Shipment
Shipping the your instrument

While out of the instrument, the battery will discharge at a slow rate. JDSU recommends checking
the battery periodically while it is in storage, and keeping it charged to at least 40%. For additional
information about maintaining the battery, see “Maintaining the battery” in the base unit manual that
shipped with your instrument.

The first time you use the instrument after prolonged storage, use the AC adapter to power up the
unit.

Shipping the your instrument


If you will be shipping the instrument, you should follow the guidelines below.

Removing the component


If you are returning the Dual Module Carrier, Transport Module, and MSAM only (rather than the
entire assembly), remove the component before shipping. For instructions, Chapter 2 “Assembling
Your Instrument”.

Packing the components


When packing the components for shipment, JDSU recommends using the original shipping
container and packing materials. If the original container and packing materials are damaged or not
available, the components should be carefully packed so that they will not be damaged in transit.
JDSU recommends using anti-static packing material to secure the components inside a box or
other container. If needed, you can obtain appropriate packing materials by contacting JDSU
Customer Care at 1-866-228-3762 or at www.jdsu.com.

NOTE:
JDSU is not liable for any damage that may occur during shipping.

Returning equipment to JDSU


Before you return any equipment to JDSU, contact JDSU Customer Care at 1-866-228-3762 or at
www.jdsu.com for the correct shipping address and for a Return or Reference Authorization. You
must have a Return or Reference Authorization whenever you return equipment to JDSU.

For each piece of equipment returned for repair, attach a tag that includes the following information:

– Owner’s name, address, and telephone number.


– The serial number, product type, and model.
– Warranty status. (If you are unsure of the warranty status of your instrument, contact JDSU
Customer Care.)
– A detailed description of the problem or service requested.
– The name and telephone number of the person to contact regarding questions about the repair.
– The return authorization (RA) number (US customers), or reference number (European
Customers).

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 209
Appendix B Storage and Shipment
Returning equipment to JDSU

Clearly mark the outside of the package with the JDSU-issued Return or Reference Authorization
number and ship it prepaid and insured to JDSU. For information on packaging equipment for ship-
ment, see “Shipping the your instrument” on page 209.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
210 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
C
Appendix C Customer Services and Support

This appendix provides information about standard support services, add-on services, and training
available through JDSU. Topics discussed in this appendix include:

– “About our services” on page 212


– “Standard support services” on page 212
– “Add-on services” on page 213
– “Training options” on page 214

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 211
Appendix C Customer Services and Support
About our services

About our services


JDSU offers an unmatched and comprehensive portfolio of standard support services, add-on
services, and training options to help customers successfully use purchased JDSU products.
Services that come standard with every product sale include business hour technical assistance,
in-warranty repair, calibration services, upgrade services, and immediate return authorizations.
Add-on services designed to optimize product capabilities and maximize efficiencies include field
engineering and deployment, technical training, 24x7 product support, consulting, and custom soft-
ware development. Refer to the sections that follow for additional details.

Standard support services


Standard support services that accompany the sale of every JDSU product include:

– Instrument repair and calibration services


– Business hour technical assistance
– Access to general warranty information on the JDSU Web site
– Extensive product documentation and related technical information, accessible on the JDSU
Web site
For more information, refer to the following subsections.

Instrument repair and calibration services


Our service centers provide repair and calibration services for JDSU equipment. JDSU understands
the impact of equipment down time on operations and is staffed to ensure a quick turnaround. Avail-
able services include the following:

Product Repair — All equipment returned for service is tested to the same rigorous standards as
newly manufactured equipment. This ensures products meet all published specifications, including
any applicable product updates.

Calibration — JDSU calibration methods are ISO approved and based on national standards.

For more information, including instructions for returning equipment for repair and/or calibration, go
to: www.jdsu.com/en-us/Test-and-Measurement/support/repair-and-calibration/Pages/
default.aspx.

Technical assistance (business hour)


Expert business hour technical support is provided with your product. For assistance related to the
use of your product, call or e-mail JDSU Technical Assistance Center (TAC) in your region. For a
current listing of TAC phone numbers and e-mail addresses, go to: www.jdsu.com/en-us/Test-and-
Measurement/support/technical-assistance/Pages/default.aspx.

For information about optional 24x7 technical assistance, see “Extended product and systems
support services” on page 213.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
212 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Appendix C Customer Services and Support
Add-on services

Warranty information
Information about standard warranties, terms, and conditions specific to JDSU Network and Service
Enablement products and third party software that may be included within such products is posted
on the JDSU Web site. For more information, go to: www.jdsu.com/terms.

Product documentation library


An extensive library that includes documentation for JDSU products and related technology-specific
documents is available on the JDSU Web site. For more information, go to: www.jdsu.com/en-us/
Test-and-Measurement/support/Technical-Library/Pages/TechLibrary.aspx.

Add-on services
JDSU offers a broad portfolio of add-on services to enable customers to aggressively build their
competitive advantage within the markets they serve. Available services include:

– Extended product and systems support, including:


– Optional extended product warranties
– Optional extended repair services
– Calibration management services
– Around-the-clock technical assistance
– A certified pre-owned equipment program
– Tailored support services for your JDSU system
– Various professional and consulting services
– Specialized managed services
For more information, refer to the following subsections.

Extended product and systems support services


For information about optional extended product warranties, go to: www.jdsu.com/en-us/Test-and-
Measurement/services/a-z-service-list/Pages/ext-warr.aspx.

For information about optional extended equipment repair services, go to: www.jdsu.com/en-us/
Test-and-Measurement/services/a-z-service-list/Pages/factory-repair.aspx.

For information about equipment calibration management services, go to: www.jdsu.com/en-us/


Test-and-Measurement/services/a-z-service-list/Pages/calibration.aspx.

For information about optional 24x7 technical assistance, go to: www.jdsu.com/en-us/Test-and-


Measurement/services/a-z-service-list/Pages/tac.aspx.

For information about JDSU Assets and Certified Equipment (ACE) Program (for the resale of certi-
fied preowned equipment), go to: www.jdsu.com/en-us/Test-and-Measurement/services/a-z-
service-list/Pages/ace-prgm.aspx.

For information about tailored support services for your JDSU system, go to: www.jdsu.com/en-us/
Test-and-Measurement/services/products-and-systems-support/systems-support/Pages/
default.aspx.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 213
Appendix C Customer Services and Support
Training options

Professional and consulting services


For information about optional professional and consulting services available from JDSU, go to:
www.jdsu.com/en-us/Test-and-Measurement/services/professional-and-consulting-services/
Pages/default.aspx.

Managed services
For information about specialized managed services available from JDSU, go to: www.jdsu.com/
en-us/Test-and-Measurement/services/managed-services/Pages/default.aspx.

Training options
JDSU offers a wide array of training options designed to support customers at various stages of the
network life cycle. Training options include:

– Public training
– On-site training
– Virtual classroom
– Self-paced training
– Certifications
– Workshops and blended learning
– Train-the-trainer/course licensing
– Free Webinars
– Contact training
For more information about available training options, go to: www.jdsu.com/en-us/Test-and-
Measurement/Training/Pages/default.aspx.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
214 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Glossary

Symbols/Numerics
10G — Used on the connector panel to represent 10 Gigabit Ethernet.

10GE — Used on the connector panel to represent 10 Gigabit Ethernet.

10GigE — Used throughout this manual to represent 10 Gigabit Ethernet.

802.11b — IEEE standard for wireless LANs. You can establish wireless LAN connections to the T-
BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800 using an 802.11 PCMCIA card.

A
AC — Alternating Current. An AC power adapter is supplied with the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800.

Assembly — Used throughout this manual to refer to a complete set of components assembled as an instru-
ment and used for testing. This manual supports three assemblies: The Transport Module assembly, the
MSAM assembly, and the DMC assembly.

B
Base unit — The unit which connects to the Transport Module and battery or power adapter, providing the
user interface and a variety of connectivity and work flow tools.

BER — Bit Error Rate.

BERT — Bit error rate test. A known pattern of bits is transmitted, and errors received are counted to figure
the BER. The Bit Error Rate test is used to measure transmission quality.

C
Component — Used throughout this manual to refer to an individual hardware component which is connected
to the other components to build a test instrument (assembly). This manual supports the following components:
the Transport Module, the MSAM, and the DMC. The base units are documented in separate manuals.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 215
Glossary

D
DHCP — Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. A communications protocol that assigns IP addresses dynam-
ically as needed. The test instrument supports static IP address assignment.

DMC — Dual Module Carrier. Two slot chassis which you can connect to the T-BERD / MTS 8000 base unit to
test using up to two MSAM application modules and four Physical Interface Modules (PIMs).

E
Ethernet — A LAN protocol. Using the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800, you can test and verify
Ethernet network elements and services.

Ethernet link partner — The nearest Ethernet device on a link. The T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800
auto-negotiates its capabilities with this device when you initialize a link.

F
FTP — File transfer protocol. Protocol used on LANs and the Internet to transfer files.

G
GE — Used on the Transport Module connector panel to represent Gigabit Ethernet.

GigE — Used throughout this manual to represent Gigabit Ethernet.

GUI — Graphical User Interface. Layout of commands in a user-friendly environment. See also UI (user inter-
face).

H
Histogram — Print output of specific results in a bar graph format.

I
ISO — International Organization for Standardization.

IP — Internet Protocol. Protocol specifying the format and address scheme of packets transmitted over the
Internet. Typically used with TCP.

L
LAN — Local Access Network.

LED — Light emitting diode.

LLB — Line loopback.

LiION — Lithium Ion. The T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A, and 5800 can be equipped with a rechargeable Lithium
Ion battery.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
216 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Glossary

M
MDI — Medium dependent interface.

MDI-X — Medium dependent interface crossover.

MSAM — Multiple Services Application Module.

Msg — Message.

O
OC-3 — Optical carrier 3. A SONET channel equal to three DS3s (155.52 Mbps).

OC-12 — Optical carrier 12. A SONET channel of 622.08 Mbps.

OC-48 — Optical Carrier 48. SONET channel of 2.488 Gbps.

OC-192 — Optical Carrier 192. SONET channel of 9.953 Gbps.

P
Packet — Bundle of data, configured for transmission. Consists of data to be transmitted and control informa-
tion.

PIM — The physical interface module inserted into one of up to two ports provided on the MSAM chassis.
Provides the interfaces used to connect to the circuit you are testing.

R
RJ 48-45 — Jack on the Transport Module used for 10/100/1000 Mbps Ethernet testing.

Rx — Receive or receiver or input.

S
SDH — Synchronous Data Hierarchy.

SONET — Synchronous optical network.

STM-1e — An electrical SDH signal of 155.52 Mbps.

STM-4 — An SDH signal of 622.08 Mbps.

STM-16 — An SDH signal of 2488.32 Mbps.

STM-64 — An SDH signal of 9.953 Gbps.

STS-1 — An electrical SONET signal of 51.84 Mbps.

Sync — Synchronization.

SyncE — Synchronized Ethernet.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
August 2014 22046561, Rev. 005 217
Glossary

T
Term — See Terminate

Terminate — An application where the test set is terminating the circuit. In these applications, the test set
sends and receives traffic.

Through — An application where the test set is used in series with a network circuit to monitor the traffic on
that circuit.

Tx — Transmit or transmitter or output.

U
USB — Universal Serial Bus. A bus designed to handle a broad range of devices, such as keyboards, mouses,
printers, modems, and hubs.

V
VNC — Virtual Network Computing. A thin client system that enables you to run applications on a VNC server
from any other computer connected to the Internet. Using VNC, you can run the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000, 6000A,
and 5800 from a remote workstation, and you can run remote applications from the T-BERD ⁄ MTS 8000,
6000A, and 5800.

W
WAN — Wide area network.

X
XFP — 10 Gigabit Small Form Factor Pluggable optical transceiver. A variety of optional XFPs are available
for testing 10 Gigabit LAN or 10 Gigabit WAN fibre circuits.

MSAM, CSAM, 40/100G Module, DMC, and 5800 Getting Started Manual
218 22046561, Rev. 005 August 2014
Network and Service Enablement Regional Sales

North America Latin America Asia Pacific EMEA www.jdsu.com


Toll Free: 1 855 ASK JDSU Tel: +55 11 5503 3800 Tel: +852 2892 0990 Tel: +49 7121 86 2222

22046561
Rev. 005, August 2014
English

You might also like